Chrysler Automobile 2004 PT Cruiser User Manual

TABLE OF CONTENTS  
SECTION  
PAGE  
1
INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121  
STARTING AND OPERATING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177  
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243  
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293  
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315  
INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325  
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
8
8
9
9
10  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INTRODUCTION  
1
CONTENTS  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
How To Use This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
Warnings And Cautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6  
Vehicle Identification Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6  
Vehicle Modifications / Alterations . . . . . . . . . . . 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
INTRODUCTION  
INTRODUCTION  
WARNING!  
This manual has been prepared with the assistance of  
service and engineering specialists to acquaint you with  
the operation and maintenance of your new vehicle. It is  
supplemented by a Warranty Information Booklet and  
various customer oriented documents. You are urged to  
read these publications carefully. Following the instruc-  
tions and recommendations in this manual will help  
assure safe and enjoyable operation of your vehicle.  
Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and certain  
vehicle components contain or emit chemicals  
known to the State of California to cause cancer and  
birth defects or other reproductive harm. In addition,  
certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain prod-  
ucts of component wear contain or emit chemicals  
known to the State of California to cause cancer and  
birth defects or other reproductive harm.  
NOTE: After you read the manual, it should be stored  
in the vehicle for convenient reference and remain with  
the vehicle when sold, so that the new owner will be  
aware of all safety warnings.  
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL  
Consult the table of contents to determine which section  
contains the information you desire.  
When it comes to service, remember that your dealer  
knows your vehicle best, has the factory-trained techni-  
cians and genuine Moparparts, and is interested in  
your satisfaction.  
The detailed index, at the rear of this manual, contains a  
complete listing of all subjects.  
Consult the following table for a description of the  
symbols that may be used on your vehicle or throughout  
this owners manual:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INTRODUCTION  
5
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
INTRODUCTION  
WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS  
This manual contains WARNINGS against operating  
procedures which could result in an accident or bodily  
injury. It also contains CAUTIONS against procedures  
which could result in damage to your vehicle. If you do  
not read this entire manual you may miss important  
information. Observe all Warnings and Cautions.  
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) is found on the  
drivers front corner of the instrument panel, visible  
through the windshield. This number also appears on the  
vehicle registration or title.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INTRODUCTION  
7
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS / ALTERATIONS  
1
WARNING!  
Any modifications or alterations to this vehicle  
could seriously affect its roadworthiness and safety  
and may lead to an accident resulting in serious  
injury or death.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
2
CONTENTS  
A Word About Your Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12  
Ignition Key Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12  
Locking Doors With The Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14  
Key-In-Ignition Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14  
Sentry Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14  
Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16  
Sentry Key Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16  
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17  
Steering Wheel Lock — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . .17  
If You Wish To Manually Lock The Steering  
Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17  
To Release The Steering Wheel Lock . . . . . . . . .17  
Automatic Transaxle Ignition Interlock System . .18  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18  
Manual Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18  
Power Door Locks — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . .19  
Central Locking/ Unlocking — If Equipped . . . .20  
Automatic Door Locks — If Equipped . . . . . . .20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
“Child-Protection” Door Lock System  
(Rear Doors) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21  
Security System Manual Override . . . . . . . . . . .27  
Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28  
Emergency Seat Back Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29  
Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30  
Auto Down Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31  
Rear Window Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31  
Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32  
Occupant Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32  
Lap/ Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33  
Adjustable Upper Shoulder Belt Anchorage . . . .38  
Lap/ Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure . . . . .39  
Seat Belt Pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41  
Seat Belts And Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . .41  
Remote Keyless Entry — If Equipped . . . . . . . . .22  
To Unlock The Doors And Liftgate . . . . . . . . . .22  
To Lock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23  
Horn Chirp Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23  
Using The Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23  
To Program Transmitters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24  
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24  
Transmitter Battery Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25  
Security Alarm System — If Equipped . . . . . . . . .26  
To Set The Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26  
To Disarm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 11  
Driver And Front Passenger Supplemental  
Exhaust Gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59  
Restraint System (SRS) - Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . .41  
Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The  
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50  
Engine Break-In Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . .59  
Safety Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60  
2
Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make  
Outside The Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS  
IGNITION KEY REMOVAL  
The dealer that sold you your new vehicle has the key  
code numbers for your vehicle locks. These numbers can  
be used to order duplicate keys from your dealer. Ask  
your dealer for these numbers and keep them in a safe  
place.  
Automatic Transaxle  
Place the shift lever in PARK and make sure that the shift  
knob push button has returned to the out position. Turn  
the ignition switch to the OFF position, then to the LOCK  
position, and remove the key.  
The double sided keys  
may be inserted into the  
locks with either side up.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 13  
NOTE: If you try to remove the key before you place the  
lever in PARK, the key may become trapped temporarily  
in the ignition cylinder. If this occurs, rotate the key to the  
right slightly, then remove the key as described. If a  
malfunction occurs, the system will trap the key in the  
ignition cylinder to warn you that this safety feature is  
inoperable. The engine can be started and stopped but  
the key cannot be removed until you obtain service.  
2
Manual Transaxle  
Depress and hold the release button located between the  
ignition switch and the instrument panel. Turn the igni-  
tion switch to the LOCK position and remove the key.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
Locking Doors With The Key  
WARNING!  
You can insert the key with either side up. To lock the  
door, turn the key rearward, to unlock the door, turn the  
key forward. See Section 7 of this manual for door lock  
lubrication.  
Leaving children in a vehicle unattended is danger-  
ous for a number of reasons. A child or others could  
be injured. Children should be warned not to touch  
the parking brake, brake pedal or the gear selector  
lever. Dont leave the keys in the ignition. A child  
could operate power windows, other controls, or  
move the vehicle.  
Key-In-Ignition Reminder  
Opening the drivers door when the key is in the ignition,  
sounds a signal to remind you to remove the key.  
NOTE: With the drivers door open, and the key in the  
ignition, the power door locks will not function.  
CAUTION!  
SENTRY KEY  
The Sentry Key Immobilizer System prevents unautho-  
rized operation of the vehicle by disabling the engine.  
The system will shut the engine off after 2 seconds of  
running if an invalid key is used to start the vehicle. This  
system utilizes ignition keys which have an electronic  
An unlocked car is an invitation to thieves. Always  
remove key from the ignition and lock all doors  
when leaving the vehicle unattended.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 15  
chip (transponder) embedded into them. Only keys that  
have been programmed to the vehicle can be used to start  
and operate the vehicle.  
If the Theft Alarm/ Immobilizer Light comes on during  
normal vehicle operation (vehicle has been running for  
longer than 10 seconds), a fault has been detected in the  
electronics and the vehicle should be serviced as soon as  
possible.  
2
The Sentry Key Immobilizer System does not need to be  
armed or activated. Operation of the system is automatic  
regardless of whether or not the vehicle is locked or  
unlocked. During normal operation, the Theft Alarm/  
Immobilizer Light will come on for three (3) seconds  
immediately after the ignition switch is turned on for a  
bulb check. Afterwards, if the bulb remains on, this  
indicates a problem with the electronics.  
NOTE:  
The Sentry Key Immobilizer System is not compatible  
with remote starting systems. Use of these systems  
may result in vehicle starting problems and loss of  
security protection.  
Exxon/ Mobil Speed Pass,™ additional Sentry Keys, or  
any other transponder equipped components on the  
same keychain will not cause a key-related (transpon-  
der) fault unless the additional part is physically held  
against the ignition key being used when starting the  
vehicle. Cell phones, pagers, or other RF electronics  
will not cause interference with this system.  
If the bulb begins to flash after the bulb check, this  
indicates that an invalid key has been used to start the  
vehicle. Both of these conditions will result in the engine  
being shut off after two (2) seconds of running.  
Keep in mind that a key which has not been programmed  
is also considered an invalid key even if it is cut to fit the  
ignition lock cylinder for that vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
16 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
All of the keys provided with your new vehicle have  
been programmed to the vehicle electronics.  
NOTE:  
When having the Sentry Key Immobilizer  
System serviced, bring all vehicle keys with you to the  
dealer.  
Replacement Keys  
Sentry Key Programming  
You can program new keys to the system if you have two  
valid sentry keys by performing the following procedure:  
NOTE: Only keys that have been programmed to the  
vehicle electronics can be used to start the vehicle. Once  
a Sentry Key has been programmed to a vehicle, it can  
not be programmed to any other vehicle.  
1. Cut the additional Sentry Key Transponder blank(s) to  
match the ignition switch lock cylinder key code.  
At the time of purchase, the original owner is provided  
with a four digit PIN number. This number is required  
for dealer replacement of keys. Duplication of keys may  
be performed at an authorized dealer or by using the  
Customer Key Programming procedure. This procedure  
consists of programming a blank key to the vehicle  
electronics. A blank key is one which has never been  
programmed.  
2. Insert the first valid key into the ignition switch and  
turn the ignition switch ON for at least 3 seconds but no  
longer than 15 seconds. Turn the ignition switch OFF and  
remove the first key.  
3. Insert the second valid key and turn the ignition  
switch ON within 15 seconds. After ten seconds a chime  
will sound and the Theft Alarm Light will begin to flash.  
Turn the ignition switch OFF and remove the second key.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 17  
4. Insert a blank Sentry Key into the ignition switch and  
turn the ignition switch ON within 60 seconds. After 10  
seconds a single chime will sound. The Theft Alarm Light  
will stop flashing, turn on for 3 seconds; then turn off.  
STEERING WHEEL LOCK — IF EQUIPPED  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a passive steering  
wheel lock. This lock prevents steering the vehicle with-  
out the ignition key. If the steering wheel is moved no  
more than 1/ 2 turn in either direction and the key is not  
in the ignition switch, the steering wheel will lock.  
2
The new Sentry Key has been programmed.  
Repeat this procedure to program up to a total of 8 keys.  
If you do not have a programmed sentry key, contact  
your dealer for details.  
If You Wish To Manually Lock The Steering  
Wheel:  
With the engine running, turn the steering wheel upside  
down, turn off the engine and remove the key. Turn the  
steering wheel slightly in either direction until the lock  
engages.  
General Information  
The Sentry Key system complies with FCC rules part 15  
and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is  
subject to the following conditions:  
To Release The Steering Wheel Lock:  
This device may not cause harmful interference.  
Insert the key in the ignition switch and start the engine.  
If the key is difficult to turn, move the wheel slightly to  
the right or left to disengage the lock.  
This device must accept any interference that may be  
received, including interference that may cause undes-  
ired operation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
18 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
NOTE: If you turned the wheel to the right to engage  
the lock, you must turn the wheel slightly to the right to  
disengage it. If you turned the wheel to the left to engage  
the lock, turn the wheel slightly to the left to disengage it.  
Automatic Transaxle Ignition Interlock System  
This system prevents the key from being removed unless  
the shift lever is in PARK and the shift knob push-button  
is out. It also prevents shifting out of PARK unless the  
key is in the OFF, or ON positions.  
DOOR LOCKS  
Manual Door Locks  
WARNING!  
Use the manual door lock plunger to lock the doors from  
inside the vehicle. If the plunger is down when the door  
is closed, the door will lock. Therefore, make sure the  
keys are not inside the vehicle before closing the door.  
For personal security, and safety in the event of an  
accident, lock the vehicle doors as you drive as well  
as when you park and leave the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 19  
Power Door Locks — If Equipped  
A door lock switch is on each front door panel. Press this  
switch to lock or unlock the doors.  
WARNING!  
When leaving the vehicle always remove the key  
from the ignition lock, and lock your vehicle. Do not  
leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with  
access to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use of  
vehicle equipment may cause severe personal inju-  
ries and death.  
2
CAUTION!  
An unlocked vehicle is an invitation to thieves.  
Always remove the key from the ignition and lock  
all of the doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
20 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
Central Locking/Unlocking — If Equipped  
4. A single chime will sound to signify that you have  
successfully disabled the double activation feature.  
All vehicle doors and liftgate are locked with the first  
turn of the key to the LOCK position. The double unlock  
activation feature requires you to turn the key in the  
cylinder lock two times within five seconds to UNLOCK  
all vehicle doors and liftgate at once. You may turn this  
feature off and unlock all the doors and liftgate with one  
turn of the key by following these instructions.  
You can turn the feature back on by repeating the above  
mentioned procedure.  
Automatic Door Locks — If Equipped  
The doors will lock automatically if:  
1. all doors are closed,  
NOTE: Steps 2 and 3 must be completed within 10  
seconds.  
2. vehicle speed is above 15 mph (24 km/ h),  
3. the accelerator pedal is depressed.  
1. Close all doors and place the key in the ignition  
switch.  
The Automatic Door Locks can be enabled or disabled by  
performing the following procedure:  
2. Cycle the ignition switch ON/ OFF four times ending  
in the OFF position.  
NOTE: Steps 2 and 3 must be completed within 10  
seconds.  
3. Press the interior door lock switch to the UNLOCK  
position.  
1. Close all doors and place the key in the ignition  
switch.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 21  
2. Cycle the ignition switch ON/ OFF four times ending  
in the OFF position.  
To use the system, open each rear door and move the  
control UP to engage. When the system on a door is  
engaged, that door can only be opened by using the  
outside door handle even if the inside door lock is in the  
unlocked position.  
3. Press the interior door lock switch to the LOCK  
position.  
2
4. A single chime will sound to signify that you have  
successfully completed the programming.  
You can turn the feature back on by repeating the above  
mentioned procedure.  
“Child-Protection” Door Lock System (Rear  
Doors)  
To provide a safer environment for children riding in the  
rear seat, the rear doors have the “child-protection” door  
lock system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
22 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
WARNING!  
Avoid trapping anyone in a vehicle in a collision.  
Remember that the rear doors can only be opened  
from the outside when the child protection locks are  
engaged.  
NOTE: For emergency exit with the system engaged,  
move the lock plunger up (unlocked position), roll down  
window and open the door with the outside door handle.  
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY — IF EQUIPPED  
This system allows you to lock or unlock the doors and  
activate the panic alarm from distances up to about 23  
feet (7 meters) using a hand held transmitter. The trans-  
mitter need not be pointed at the vehicle to activate the  
system.  
To Unlock The Doors and Liftgate:  
Press and release the UNLOCK button on the key fob  
once to unlock the drivers door, or twice within five  
seconds to unlock all doors and liftgate, the park lights  
will also flash twice. The interior lights also come on and  
remain on for about 30 seconds when you unlock the  
doors.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 23  
NOTE: You may turn off this feature and unlock all  
doors with one press of the button by following the  
procedure shown in the Central Locking/ Unlocking  
paragraph.  
3. Continue to hold the Unlock button and press the  
Lock button.  
4. Release both buttons.  
2
A chime will sound to signify that the process is com-  
plete.  
To Lock The Doors:  
Press and release the LOCK button to lock all doors and  
liftgate. The park lights will flash and the horn will chirp  
to acknowledge the signal.  
Using The Panic Alarm:  
To turn on the panic alarm feature, press and release the  
PANIC button. When the panic alarm is on the headlights  
and park lights will flash, the horn will pulse on and off  
and the interior lights will turn on.  
Horn Chirp Feature  
The horn chirp that signals that the doors have been  
locked can be turned on or off by using the following  
procedure:  
The panic alarm will stay on for 3 minutes unless you  
press the PANIC button a second time, or until vehicle  
speed reaches 15 mph (24 km/ h).  
1. Insert the key into the ignition switch and turn the  
switch to the ON position.  
NOTE: When you turn off the panic alarm by pressing  
the PANIC button a second time, you may have to be  
closer to the vehicle due to the radio frequency noises of  
the system.  
2. Press and hold the Unlock button on the transmitter  
for between four and ten seconds.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
24 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
To Program Transmitters  
5. Turn the ignition switch off to exit the transmitter  
programming mode.  
Up to four transmitters can be programmed to your  
vehicle. Your new vehicle was shipped with two trans-  
mitters. See your dealer for additional transmitters  
General Information  
This device complies with FCC rules part 15 and with  
RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the  
following conditions:  
Additional transmitters can be programmed to the sys-  
tem by using the following procedure:  
1. Insert the key into the ignition switch and turn the  
switch to the ON position.  
This device may not cause harmful interference.  
This device must accept any interference that may be  
received, including interference that may cause undes-  
ired operation.  
2. Press and hold the Unlock button on the transmitter  
between four and ten seconds.  
3. Continue to hold the Unlock button and press the  
Panic button. A chime will sound to indicate that the  
transmitter programming mode has been entered.  
If your transmitter fails to operate from a normal dis-  
tance, check for these two conditions.  
1. Weak batteries in transmitter. The expected life of  
batteries is from one to two years.  
4. Press a button on all transmitters to be programmed to  
the system, including any previously programmed trans-  
mitters. A chime will sound when each transmitter has  
been programmed.  
2. Closeness to a radio transmitter such as a radio station  
tower, airport transmitter, and some mobile or CB radios.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 25  
Transmitter Battery Service  
The recommended replacement battery is 2016 or its  
equivalent.  
2
NOTE: Do not touch the battery terminals that are on  
the back housing or the printed circuit board.  
1. With the transmitter buttons facing down, use a thin  
coin to pry the two halves of the transmitter apart. Make  
sure not to damage the rubber gasket during removal.  
2. Remove and replace the batteries. Avoid touching the  
new batteries with your fingers. Skin oils may cause  
battery deterioration. If you touch a battery, clean it with  
rubbing alcohol.  
3. To reassemble the transmitter case snap two halves  
together. Make sure there is an even gap between the two  
halves. Test transmitter operation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
26 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
SECURITY ALARM SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPED  
The system monitors the doors, liftgate, and ignition  
switch for unauthorized operation.  
To set the alarm:  
1. Remove the keys from the ignition switch and get out  
of the vehicle.  
If something triggers the alarm, the system will signal for  
about 18 minutes. For the first 3 minutes the horn will  
sound and the headlights, park lights, tail lights and the  
indicator light in the cluster will flash. Then the exterior  
lights will flash for another 15 minutes.  
2. Lock the door using either the door key, power door  
lock switch, or the Keyless Entry Transmitter and close all  
doors.  
3. The indicator light in the instrument cluster will flash  
rapidly for 16 seconds. This shows that the system is  
arming. During this period, if a door is opened, the  
ignition switch is turned ON, or the power door locks are  
unlocked in any manner, the system will automatically  
disarm. After 16 seconds the indicator light will flash  
slowly. This shows that the system is fully armed.  
If the monitored system, which triggered the alarm is  
deactivated the alarm will continue to sound until 3  
minutes of alarm time is reached. If the monitored  
system, which triggered the alarm is deactivated after the  
alarm has been on for 3 minutes the alarm will shut off  
immediately.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 27  
To disarm the system:  
Unlock a front door/ liftgate using either the key or the  
Keyless Entry Transmitter.  
Security System Manual Override  
The system will not arm if you lock the doors using the  
manual door lock plunger.  
2
Starting the vehicle with a valid Sentry key will disarm  
the system. A valid key is one that is programmed to that  
particular vehicle. A valid key will disarm the system, an  
invalid key will trigger the alarm.  
Tamper Alert  
If the horn sounds 3 times when you unlock a front door  
using either a key or the Keyless Entry Transmitter, the  
alarm has been activated. Check the vehicle for tamper-  
ing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
28 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
LIFTGATE  
WARNING!  
NOTE: The key that is used to start the vehicle is also  
used to lock or unlock the doors and open the liftgate.  
Driving with the liftgate open can allow poison-  
ous exhaust gases into your vehicle. You and your  
passengers could be injured by these fumes. Keep  
the liftgate closed when you are operating the  
vehicle.  
To open the liftgate, insert the key into the lock and turn  
to the left. The liftgate can also be unlocked using the  
remote keyless entry or by activating the power door lock  
switches located on the front doors. The central locking/  
unlocking feature (if equipped) can also be activated  
from the liftgate key cylinder.  
If you are required to drive with the liftgate open,  
make sure that all windows are closed, and the  
climate control blower switch is set at high speed.  
DO NOT use the recirculation mode.  
Once unlocked, the liftgate can be opened or closed  
without using the key. To open the liftgate, pull out on  
the outside handle and lift up with one fluid motion.  
Gas props support the liftgate in the open position.  
However, because the gas pressure drops with tempera-  
ture, it may be necessary to assist the props when  
opening the liftgate in cold weather.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 29  
EMERGENCY SEAT BACK RELEASE  
position 1 (Top) or position 2 (Middle), the left side rear  
seat back can be unlatched by pulling down on the  
glow-in-the-dark lever attached to the left rear seat back  
latching mechanism.  
WARNING!  
2
Do not allow children to have access to the liftgate  
area with the rear shelf panel in position 1 (Top) or  
position 2 (Middle), either by climbing into the  
liftgate from outside, or through the inside of the  
vehicle. Always close the liftgate when your vehicle  
is unattended. Once in the liftgate area, young chil-  
dren may not be able to escape, even if they entered  
through the rear seat. If trapped in the liftgate,  
children can die from suffocation or heat stroke.  
As a security measure, a Seat Back Emergency Release  
lever is built into the left side rear seat back latching  
mechanism. In the event of an individual being locked  
inside the liftgate area with the rear shelf panel in  
Once unlatched the seat back can be pushed forward to  
gain access into the interior of the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
30 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
NOTE: Make sure that the elastic loop is around the  
emergency release handle at all times. If the handle is  
pulled downward, entirely through the elastic loop, the  
handle will not return to its original position and the seat  
back may not operate properly.  
The window lock switch located between the window  
switches allows you to disable the rear window switches  
that are located at the back of the center floor console.  
POWER WINDOWS  
The power window switches are located on the instru-  
ment panel above the A/ C controls. The top left switch  
controls the left front window and the top right switch  
controls the right front window.  
The lower left switch controls the left rear passengers  
window and the lower right switch controls the right rear  
passengers window.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 31  
Rear Window Switches  
There are also rear passenger window switches located at  
the rear of the center console near the floor.  
WARNING!  
Never leave children in a vehicle, with the keys in  
the ignition switch. Occupants, particularly unat-  
tended children, can become entrapped by the win-  
dows while operating the power window switches.  
Such entrapment may result in serious injury or  
death.  
2
Auto Down Feature  
The drivers and passengers front window switches  
have an auto down feature. Press the window switch past  
the detent, release, and the window will go down auto-  
matically. Press the switch a second time in either direc-  
tion to stop the window.  
To open the window part way, press the window switch  
part way and release it when you want the window to  
stop.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
32 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
Wind Buffeting  
adult-size seat belts, your seat belts or the LATCH feature  
also, can be used to hold infant and child restraint  
systems.  
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of  
pressure on the ears or a helicopter type sound in the  
ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the  
windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain  
open or partially open positions. This is a normal occur-  
rence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with  
the rear windows open, open the front and rear windows  
together to minimize the buffeting. If the buffeting occurs  
with the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to  
minimize the buffeting.  
Please pay close attention to the information in this  
section. It tells you how to use your restraint system  
properly to keep you and your passengers as safe as  
possible.  
WARNING!  
In a collision, you and your passengers can suffer  
much greater injuries if you are not properly buck-  
led up. You can strike the interior of your vehicle or  
other passengers, or you can be thrown out of the  
vehicle. Always be sure you and others in your  
vehicle are buckled up properly.  
OCCUPANT RESTRAINTS  
Some of the most important safety features in your  
vehicle are the restraint systems. These include the front  
and rear seat belts for the driver and all passengers, front  
airbags for both the driver and front passenger and if  
equipped, side airbags for both the driver and front  
passenger. If you will be carrying children too small for  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 33  
Buckle up even though you are an excellent driver, even  
on short trips. Someone on the road may be a poor driver  
and cause a collision that includes you. This can happen  
far away from home or on your own street.  
The belt webbing retractor is designed to lock during  
very sudden stops or collisions. This feature allows the  
shoulder part of the belt to move freely with you under  
normal conditions. But in a collision, the belt will lock  
and reduce the risk of your striking the inside of the  
vehicle or being thrown out.  
2
Research has shown that seat belts save lives, and they  
can reduce the seriousness of injuries in a collision. Some  
of the worst injuries happen when people are thrown  
from the vehicle. Seat belts reduce the possibility of  
ejection and the risk of injury caused by striking the  
inside of the vehicle. Everyone in a motor vehicle should  
be belted at all times.  
WARNING!  
It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,  
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision,  
people riding in these areas are more likely to be  
seriously injured or killed.  
Lap/Shoulder Belts  
All the seats in your vehicle are equipped with Lap/  
Shoulder Belts.  
Do not allow people to ride in any area of your  
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat  
belts.  
Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and  
using a seat belt properly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
34 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
Lap/Shoulder Belt Operating Instructions  
WARNING!  
1. Enter the vehicle and close the door. Sit back and  
adjust the seat.  
Wearing a seat belt incorrectly is dangerous. Seat  
belts are designed to go around the large bones of  
your body. These are the strongest parts of your  
body and can take the forces of a collision the  
best.  
2. The seat belt latch plate is above the back of the front  
seat, next to your arm. Grasp the latch plate and pull out  
the belt. Slide the latch plate up the webbing as far as  
necessary to allow the belt to go around your lap.  
Wearing your belt in the wrong place could make  
your injuries in a collision much worse. You  
might suffer internal injuries, or you could even  
slide out of part of the belt. Follow these instruc-  
tions to wear your seat belt safely and to keep  
your passengers safe, too.  
Two people should never be belted into a single  
seat belt. People belted together can crash into one  
another in an accident, hurting one another badly.  
Never use a lap/shoulder belt or lap belt for more  
than one person, no matter what their size.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 35  
3. When the belt is long enough to fit, insert the latch  
plate into the buckle until you hear a “click.”  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
36 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
4. Position the lap belt across your thighs, below your  
abdomen. To remove slack in the lap belt portion, pull up  
on the shoulder belt. To loosen the lap belt if it is too tight,  
tilt the latch plate and pull on the lap belt. A snug belt  
reduces the risk of sliding under the belt in a collision.  
WARNING!  
A belt that is buckled into the wrong buckle will not  
protect you properly. The lap portion could ride too  
high on your body, possibly causing internal inju-  
ries. Always buckle your belt into the buckle nearest  
you.  
A belt that is too loose will not protect you as well. In  
a sudden stop you could move too far forward,  
increasing the possibility of injury. Wear your seat  
belt snugly.  
A belt that is worn under your arm is very danger-  
ous. Your body could strike the inside surfaces of the  
vehicle in a collision, increasing head and neck  
injury. A belt worn under the arm can cause internal  
injuries. Ribs arent as strong as shoulder bones.  
Wear the belt over your shoulder so that your stron-  
gest bones will take the force in a collision.  
A shoulder belt placed behind you will not protect  
you from injury during a collision. You are more  
likely to hit your head in a collision if you do not  
wear your shoulder belt. The lap and shoulder belt  
are meant to be used together.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 37  
6. To release the belt, push the red button on the buckle.  
The belt will automatically retract to its stowed position.  
If necessary, slide the latch plate down the webbing to  
allow the belt to retract fully.  
WARNING!  
A lap belt worn too high can increase the risk of  
internal injury in a collision. The belt forces wont  
be at the strong hip and pelvic bones, but across your  
abdomen. Always wear the lap belt as low as pos-  
sible and keep it snug.  
2
WARNING!  
A frayed or torn belt could rip apart in a collision  
and leave you with no protection. Inspect the belt  
system periodically, checking for cuts, frays, or loose  
parts. Damaged parts must be replaced immediately.  
Do not disassemble or modify the system. Seat belt  
assemblies must be replaced after a collision if they  
have been damaged (bent retractor, torn webbing,  
etc.).  
A twisted belt cant do its job as well. In a collision  
it could even cut into you. Be sure the belt is straight.  
If you cant straighten a belt in your vehicle, take it  
to your dealer and have it fixed.  
5. Position the shoulder belt on your chest so that it is  
comfortable and not resting on your neck. The retractor  
will withdraw any slack in the belt.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
38 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
Rear Center Lap/Shoulder Belt Retractor Lock-Out  
This feature is designed to lock the retractor whenever  
the rear seat back is not fully latched. This prevents  
someone from wearing the rear center lap/ shoulder belt  
when the rear seat back is not fully latched.  
WARNING!  
The rear center lap/shoulder belt is equipped with a  
lock-out feature to ensure that the rear seat back is in  
the fully upright and locked position when occu-  
pied. If the rear seat back is not fully upright and  
locked and the rear center lap/shoulder belt can be  
pulled out of the retractor, the vehicle should imme-  
diately be taken to your dealer for service. Failure to  
follow this warning could result in serious or fatal  
injury.  
NOTE:  
If the rear center lap/ shoulder belt can not be pulled  
out, check that the rear seat back is fully latched.  
If the rear seat back is properly latched and the rear  
center lap/ shoulder belt still can not be pulled out, the  
Automatic-Locking Retractor (ALR) system may be  
activated. To reset this feature you must let all of the  
belt webbing return into the retractor. You will not be  
able to pull out more webbing until all of the webbing  
has been returned back into the retractor.  
Adjustable Upper Shoulder Belt Anchorage  
In the front seat, the shoulder belt can be adjusted  
upward or downward to position the belt away from  
your neck. Push up or down on the anchorage button to  
release the anchorage, and move it up or down to the  
position that serves you best.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 39  
Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure  
Use the following procedure to untwist a twisted lap/  
shoulder belt.  
2
1. Position the latch plate as close as possible to the  
anchor point.  
As a guide, if you are shorter than average, you will  
prefer a lower position, and if you are taller than average,  
youll prefer a higher position. When you release the  
anchorage, try to move it up or down to make sure that  
it is locked in position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
40 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
2. At about 6 to 12 inches (15 to 30 cm) above the latch  
plate, grasp and twist the belt webbing 180° to create a  
fold that begins immediately above the latch plate.  
3. Slide the latch plate upward over the folded webbing.  
The folded webbing must enter the slot at the top of the  
latch plate.  
4. Continue to slide the latch plate up until it clears the  
folded webbing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 41  
Seat Belt Pretensioners  
Seat Belts And Pregnant Women  
The seat belts for both front seating positions are  
equipped with pretensioning devices that are designed to  
remove slack from the seat belt in the event of a collision.  
These devices improve the performance of the seat belt  
by assuring that the belt is tight about the occupant early  
in a collision. Pretensioners work for all size occupants,  
including those in child restraints.  
We recommend that pregnant women use the seat belts  
throughout their pregnancy. Keeping the mother safe is  
the best way to keep the baby safe.  
2
Pregnant women should wear the lap part of the belt  
across the thighs and as snug across the hips as possible.  
Keep the belt low so that it does not come across the  
abdomen. That way the strong bones of the hips will take  
the force if there is a collision.  
NOTE: These devices are not a substitute for proper seat  
belt placement by the occupant. The seat belt still must be  
worn snugly and positioned properly.  
Driver and Front Passenger Supplemental  
Restraint System (SRS) - Airbag  
The pretensioners are triggered by the front airbag con-  
trol module (see Airbag Section). Like the front airbags,  
the pretensioners are single use items. After a collision  
that is severe enough to deploy the airbags and preten-  
sioners, both must be replaced.  
This vehicle has airbags for both the driver and front  
passenger as a supplement to the seat belt restraint  
systems. The drivers front airbag is mounted in the  
center of the steering wheel. The passengers front airbag  
is mounted in the instrument panel, above the glove  
compartment. The words SRS AIRBAG are embossed on  
the airbag covers.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
42 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
If the vehicle is equipped with side airbags, they are  
located inside the driver and front passenger seats, and  
their covers are also labeled SRS AIRBAG.  
NOTE: The front airbags are certified to the Federal  
regulations that allow less forceful deployment.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 43  
Airbags inflate in moderate to high speed impacts. Along  
with seat belts and pretensioners, front airbags work with  
the instrument panel knee bolsters to provide improved  
protection for the driver and front passenger. Side airbags  
also work with seat belts to improve occupant protection.  
WARNING!  
Do not put anything on or around the airbag covers  
or attempt to manually open them. You may dam-  
age the airbags and you could be injured because  
the airbags are not there to protect you. These  
protective covers for the airbag cushions are de-  
signed to open only when the airbags are inflating.  
2
The seat belts are designed to protect you in many types  
of collisions. The front airbags deploy in moderate to  
severe frontal collisions. If your vehicle is equipped, the  
side airbag on the crash side of the vehicle is triggered in  
moderate to severe side collisions. In certain types of  
collisions, both the front and side airbags may be trig-  
gered. But even in collisions where the airbags work, you  
need the seat belts to keep you in the right position for  
the airbags to protect you properly.  
If your vehicle is equipped with side airbags, do  
not use accessory seat covers or place objects  
between you and the side airbags; the perfor-  
mance could be adversely affected and/or objects  
could be pushed into you, causing serious injury.  
If your vehicle is equipped with side airbags, do  
not attach cup holders or any other objects on or  
around the door. The inflating side airbag could  
drive the object into occupants, causing serious  
injury.  
Here are some simple steps you can take to minimize the  
risk of harm from a deploying airbag.  
1. Children 12 years old and under should always ride  
buckled up in a rear seat.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
44 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
Infants in rear facing child restraints should NEVER ride  
in the front seat of a vehicle with a passenger front airbag.  
An airbag deployment can cause severe injury or death to  
infants in that position.  
You should read the instructions provided with your  
child restraint to make sure that you are using it properly.  
2. All occupants should wear their lap and shoulder  
belts properly.  
Children that are not big enough to properly wear the  
vehicle seat belt (see Section on Child Restraints) should  
be secured in the rear seat in child restraints or belt-  
positioning booster seats. Older children who do not use  
child restraints or belt-positioning booster seats should  
ride properly buckled up in the rear seat. Never allow  
children to slide the shoulder belt behind them or under  
their arm.  
3. The driver and front passenger seats should be  
moved back as far as practical to allow the front airbags  
room to inflate.  
4. If your vehicle has side airbags, do not lean against  
the door, airbags will inflate forcefully into the space  
between you and the door.  
If a child from 1 to 12 years old must ride in the front  
passenger seat because the vehicle is crowded, move the  
seat as far back as possible, and use the proper child  
restraint. Refer to the section on Child Restraint.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 45  
The front airbag system consists of the following:  
WARNING!  
Front Airbag Control Module (ACM)  
AIRBAG Readiness Light  
Relying on the airbags alone could lead to more  
severe injuries in a collision. The airbags work  
with your seat belt to restrain you properly. In  
some collisions the airbags wont deploy at all.  
Always wear your seat belts even though you  
have airbags.  
2
Driver and Passenger Front Airbag/ Inflator Units  
Unique Steering Wheel and Column  
Unique Instrument Panel  
Being too close to the steering wheel or instru-  
ment panel during front airbag deployment could  
cause serious injury. Airbags need room to inflate.  
Sit back, comfortably extending your arms to  
reach the steering wheel or instrument panel.  
Interconnecting Wiring  
Seat Belt Pretensioners  
Knee Impact Bolster  
The Side Airbag System, on vehicles equipped, consists  
of the following:  
If the vehicle has side airbags, they also need  
room to inflate. Do not lean against the door. Sit  
upright in the center of the seat.  
AIRBAG Readiness Light (shared with the front airbag  
system)  
Side Airbag in the drivers seat  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
46 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
Side Airbag in the passengers seat  
position, in the ACC position, or not in the ignition  
switch, the airbags are not on and will not inflate.  
Airbag Control Module (shared with the front airbag  
system)  
The front airbag control module also turns on  
the AIRBAG light in the instrument panel for 6  
to 8 seconds when the ignition switch is first  
turned ON, then turns the light off. If the front or side  
airbag control modules detect a malfunction in any  
part of the system, the airbag light will turn on either  
momentarily or continuously.  
Side impact sensors  
Interconnecting Wiring  
How The Airbag System Works  
The front airbag control module determines if a frontal  
impact is severe enough to require the airbags to  
inflate. The front control module will not detect side,  
roll over, or rear collisions.  
WARNING!  
Ignoring the AIRBAG light in your instrument panel  
could mean you wont have the airbags to protect  
you in a collision. If the light does not come on, stays  
on after you start the vehicle, or if it comes on as you  
drive, have the airbag system checked right away.  
The front airbag control module also monitors the  
readiness of the electronic parts of the system when-  
ever the ignition switch is in the START or ON  
positions. These include all of the items listed above  
except the knee bolster, instrument panel and the  
steering wheel and column. If the key is in the OFF  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 47  
When the front airbag control module detects a colli-  
sion requiring the front airbags, it signals the inflator  
units. A large quantity of nontoxic gas is generated to  
inflate the front airbags. The front airbag covers sepa-  
rate and fold out of the way as the front airbags inflate  
to their full size. The front airbags fully inflate in about  
50 milliseconds. This is only about half of the time it  
takes you to blink your eyes. The front airbags then  
quickly deflate while helping to restrain the driver and  
front passenger. The drivers front airbag gas is vented  
through the airbag material towards the instrument  
panel. The passengers front airbag gas is vented  
through vent holes in the sides of the airbag. In this  
way the front airbags do not interfere with your  
control of the vehicle.  
Side Airbags Supplemental Restraint System  
(SRS)—If Equipped  
The side airbag control module determines if a side  
collision is severe enough to require the side airbags to  
inflate. The side airbag control module will not detect roll  
over, front or rear collisions.  
2
The Side Airbag Control Module monitors the readiness  
of the electronic parts of the system whenever the igni-  
tion switch is in the START or ON positions. These  
include all of the items listed under “The Side Airbag  
System”, on vehicles equipped, consists of the follow-  
ing”.  
In moderate to severe side collisions, the side airbag  
inflator on the crash side of the vehicle is triggered,  
releasing a quantity of nontoxic gas. The inflating side  
airbag exits through the seat seam into the space between  
the occupant and the door. The side airbag moves at a  
very high speed and with such a high force, that it could  
The Knee Impact Bolsters help protect the knees and  
position you for the best interaction with the front  
airbags.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
48 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
injure you if you are not seated properly, or if items are  
positioned in the area where the side airbag inflates. This  
especially applies to children.  
you might get sliding along a carpet or gymnasium  
floor. They are not caused by contact with chemicals.  
They are not permanent and normally heal quickly.  
However, if you havent healed significantly within a  
few days, or if you have any blistering, see your doctor  
immediately.  
If A Deployment Occurs  
The airbag systems are designed to deploy when the  
airbag control modules detect a moderate-to-severe col-  
lision, to help restrain the driver and front passenger, and  
then immediately deflate.  
As the airbags deflate you may see some smoke-like  
particles. The particles are a normal by-product of the  
process that generates the nontoxic gas used for airbag  
inflation. These airborne particles may irritate the skin,  
eyes, nose, or throat. If you have skin or eye irritation,  
rinse the area with cool water. For nose or throat  
irritation, move to fresh air. If the irritation continues,  
see your doctor. If these particles settle on your  
clothing, follow the garment manufacturers instruc-  
tions for cleaning.  
NOTE: A collision that is not severe enough to need  
airbag protection will not activate the system. This does  
not mean something is wrong with the airbag system.  
If you do have a collision which deploys the airbags, any  
or all of the following may occur:  
The nylon airbag material may sometimes cause abra-  
sions and/ or skin reddening to the driver and front  
passenger as the airbags deploy and unfold. The  
abrasions are similar to friction rope burns or those  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 49  
It is not advisable to drive your vehicle after the  
airbags have deployed. If you are involved in another  
collision, the airbags and seat belt pretensioners will  
not be in place to protect you.  
Maintaining Your Airbag System  
WARNING!  
2
Modifications to any part of the airbag system  
could cause it to fail when you need it. You could  
be injured because the airbags are not there to  
protect you. Do not modify the components or  
wiring, including adding any kind of badges or  
stickers to the steering wheel hub trim cover or  
the upper right side of the instrument panel. Do  
not modify the front bumper, vehicle body struc-  
ture, or frame.  
WARNING!  
Deployed airbags and seat belt pretensioners cannot  
protect you in another collision. Have the airbags  
and seat belt pretensioners replaced by an autho-  
rized dealer as soon as possible.  
You need proper knee impact protection in a  
collision. Do not mount or locate any aftermarket  
equipment on or behind the knee bolsters.  
It is dangerous to try to repair any part of the  
airbag system yourself. Be sure to tell anyone who  
works on your vehicle that it has airbags.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
50 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
Airbag Light  
Child Restraint  
You will want to have the airbags ready to inflate for your  
protection in a collision. While the airbag system is  
designed to be maintenance free, if any of the following  
occurs, have an authorized dealer service the system  
immediately.  
Everyone in your vehicle needs to be buckled up at all  
times — babies and children, too. Every state in the  
United States and all Canadian provinces require that  
small children ride in proper restraint systems. This is the  
law, and you can be prosecuted for ignoring it.  
The AIRBAG light does not come on or flickers during  
the 6 to 8 seconds when the ignition switch is first  
turned on.  
Children 12 years and under should ride properly buck-  
led up in a rear seat, if available. According to crash  
statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in  
the rear seats, rather than in the front.  
The light remains on or flickers after the 6 to 8 second  
interval.  
The light flickers or comes on and remains on while  
driving.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 51  
Safety experts recommend that children ride  
rearward-facing in the vehicle until they are at least  
one year old and weigh at least 20 lbs (9 kg). Two types  
of child restraints can be used rearward-facing: infant  
carriers and ЉconvertibleЉ child seats. Both types of  
child restraints are held in the vehicle by the lap/  
shoulder belt or the LATCH child restraint anchorage  
system.  
WARNING!  
In a collision, an unrestrained child, even a tiny  
baby, can become a missile inside the vehicle. The  
force required to hold even an infant on your lap  
could become so great that you could not hold the  
child, no matter how strong you are. The child and  
others could be badly injured. Any child riding in  
your vehicle should be in a proper restraint for the  
childs size.  
2
The infant carrier is only used rearward-facing in the  
vehicle. It is recommended for children who weigh up  
to about 20 lbs (9 kg). ЉConvertibleЉ child seats can be  
used either rearward-facing or forward-facing in the  
vehicle. Convertible child seats often have a higher  
weight limit in the rearward-facing direction than  
infant carriers do, so they can be used rearward-facing  
by children who weigh more than 9 kg (20 lbs) but are  
less than one year old.  
Infants And Small Children  
There are different sizes and types of restraints for  
children from newborn size to the child almost large  
enough for an adult safety belt. Always check the child  
seat owners manual to ensure you have the correct seat  
for your child. Use the restraint that is correct for your  
child:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
52 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
Rearward-facing child seats must NEVER be used in  
the front seat of a vehicle with a front passenger  
airbag. An airbag deployment could cause severe  
injury or death to infants in this position.  
The belt-positioning booster seat is for children weigh-  
ing more than 40 lbs (18 kg), but who are still too small  
to fit the vehicles seat belts properly. If the child  
cannot sit with knees bent over the vehicles cushion  
while the childs back is against the seat back; they  
should use a Belt Positioning Booster Seat. The child  
and booster seat are held in the vehicle by the lap/  
shoulder belt. (Some booster seats are equipped with a  
front shield and are held in the vehicle by the lap  
portion.)  
Children who weigh more than 20 lbs (9 kg) and who  
are older than one year can ride forward-facing in the  
vehicle. Forward-facing child seats and convertible  
child seats used in the forward-facing direction are for  
children who weigh 20 to 40 lbs (9 to 18 kg) and who  
are older than one year. These child seats are also held  
in the vehicle by the lap/ shoulder belt or the LATCH  
child restraint anchorage system.  
NOTE:  
For  
additional information  
refer  
to  
www.nhtsa.dot.gov or www.seatcheck.org.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 53  
that you can install the child restraint in the vehicle  
where you will use it, before you buy it.  
WARNING!  
Improper installation can lead to failure of an  
infant or child restraint. It could come loose in a  
collision. The child could be badly injured or  
killed. Follow the manufacturers directions ex-  
actly when installing an infant or child restraint.  
The restraint must be appropriate for your childs  
weight and height. Check the label on the restraint for  
weight and height limits.  
2
Carefully follow the instructions that come with the  
restraint. If you install the restraint improperly, it may  
not work when you need it.  
A rearward facing child restraint should only be  
used in a rear seat. A rearward facing child re-  
straint in the front seat may be struck by a  
deploying passenger airbag which may cause se-  
vere or fatal injury to the infant.  
The passenger seat belts are equipped with either  
cinching latch plates or switchable seat belt retractors,  
which are designed to keep the lap portion tight  
around the child restraint so that it is not necessary to  
use a locking clip. If the seat belt has a cinching latch  
plate, pulling up on the shoulder portion of the  
lap/ shoulder belt will tighten the belt. The cinching  
latch plate will keep the belt tight, however, any seat  
belt system will loosen with time, so check the belt  
occasionally and pull it tight if necessary.  
Here are some tips on getting the most out of your child  
restraint:  
Before buying any restraint system, make sure that it  
has a label certifying that it meets all applicable Safety  
Standards. We also recommend that you make sure  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
54 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
If the seat belt has a switchable retractor, it will have a  
distinctive label.  
When your child restraint is not in use, secure it in the  
vehicle with the seat belt or remove it from the vehicle.  
Dont leave it loose in the vehicle. In a sudden stop or  
collision, it could strike the occupants or seat backs  
and cause serious personal injury.  
In the rear seat, you may have trouble tightening the  
lap/ shoulder belt on the child restraint because the  
buckle or latch plate is too close to the belt path  
opening on the restraint. Disconnect the latch plate  
from the buckle and twist the short buckle end of the  
belt several times to shorten it. Insert the latch plate  
into the buckle with the release button facing out.  
Automatic-Locking Retractor (ALR)  
Pull the belt from the retractor until there is enough to  
allow you to pass through the child restraint and slide the  
latch plate into the buckle. Then pull on the belt until it is  
all removed from the retractor. Allow the belt to return  
into the retractor, pulling on the excess webbing to  
tighten the lap portion about the child restraint. Follow  
the instructions of the child restraint manufacture.  
If the belt still cant be tightened, or if by pulling and  
pushing on the restraint loosens the belt, disconnect  
the latch plate from the buckle, turn the buckle  
around, and insert the latch plate into the buckle  
again. If you still cant make the child restraint secure,  
try a different seating position.  
NOTE: To reset this feature you must let all of the belt  
webbing return into the retractor. You will not be able to  
pull out more webbing until all of the webbing has been  
returned back into the retractor.  
Buckle the child into the seat according to the child  
restraint manufacturers directions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 55  
Lower Anchors and Tether for CHildren (LATCH)  
Your vehicle is equipped with the child restraint anchor-  
age system called LATCH, which stands for Lower  
Anchors and Tether for CHildren. The LATCH system  
provides for the installation of the child restraint without  
using the vehicle seat belt. All three rear seating positions  
have exclusive lower anchorages located at the rear of the  
seat cushion. They are round bars, part of the seat and  
body structure, and are readily visible. In addition, there  
are tether strap anchorages behind each rear seating  
position, located in the rear surface of the seat back.  
2
Child restraints systems having attachments designed to  
connect to the lower anchorages are now available. Child  
restraints having tether straps and hooks for connection  
to the top tether anchorage have been available for some  
time. In fact, many child restraint manufacturers will  
provide add-on tether strap kits for some of their older  
products. Tether anchorage kits are also available for  
most older vehicles.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
56 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
Because the lower anchorages are to be introduced to  
passenger carrying vehicles over a period of years, child  
restraint systems having attachments for those anchor-  
ages will continue to have features for installation in  
vehicles using the lap or lap/ shoulder belt. They will also  
have tether straps, and you are urged to take advantage  
of all of the available attachments provided with your  
child restraint in any vehicle.  
WARNING!  
Do not install child restraint systems equipped with  
LATCH attachments at all three rear seating posi-  
tions at one time. The LATCH anchorages are de-  
signed to restrain no more than two child restraints  
at a time in the event of a collision.  
Installing the Child Restraint System  
We urge that you carefully follow the directions of the  
manufacturer when installing your child restraint. Many,  
but not all, restraint systems will be equipped with  
separate straps on each side, with each having a hook or  
connector and a means for adjusting the tension in the  
strap. Forward-facing toddler restraints and some  
rearward-facing infant restraints will also be equipped  
with a tether strap with a hook and means for adjusting  
the tension in the strap.  
While there are LATCH anchorages at all three rear  
seating positions, do not install child restraints at all three  
positions at the same time. The anchorages are not  
designed to restrain three child restraints at one time.  
Instead, you may install one child restraint at the center  
position, or two child restraints at the right and left  
positions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 57  
In general, you will first loosen the adjusters on the lower  
and tether straps so that you can more easily attach the  
hook or connector to the lower and tether anchorages.  
The tether strap should be routed under the center of the  
head restraint and attached to the tether anchor on the  
rear of the seat back. Then tighten all three straps as you  
push the child restraint rearward and downward into the  
seat.  
2
Not all child restraint systems will be installed as we  
have described here. Again, carefully follow the instruc-  
tions that come with the child restraint system.  
NOTE: If your child restraint seat is not LATCH com-  
patible, install the restraint using the vehicle seat belts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
58 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
Check belt fit periodically. A childs squirming or  
slouching can move the belt out of position.  
WARNING!  
An incorrectly anchored tether strap could lead to  
increased head motion and possible injury to the  
child. Use only the anchor position directly behind  
the child seat to secure a child restraint top tether  
strap.  
If the shoulder belt contacts the face or neck, move the  
child closer to the center of the vehicle. Never allow a  
child to put the shoulder belt under an arm or behind  
their back.  
Transporting Pets  
Airbags deploying in the front seat could harm your pet.  
An unrestrained pet will be thrown about and possibly  
injured, or injure a passenger during panic braking or in  
a collision.  
Children Too Large For Booster Seats  
Children who are large enough to wear the shoulder belt  
comfortably, and whose legs are long enough to bend  
over the front of the seat when their back is against the  
seat back, should use the lap/ shoulder belt in a rear seat.  
Pets should be restrained in the rear seat in pet harnesses  
or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts.  
Make sure that the child is upright in the seat.  
The lap portion should be low on the hips and as snug  
as possible.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 59  
ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS  
A long break-in period is not required for the engine in  
your new vehicle.  
A new engine may consume some oil during its first few  
thousand miles (kilometers) of operation. This should be  
considered as a normal part of the break-in and not  
interpreted as an indication of difficulty.  
2
Drive moderately during the first 300 miles (500 km).  
After the initial 60 miles (100 km), speeds up to 50 or 55  
mph (80 or 90 km/ h) are desirable.  
SAFETY TIPS  
Exhaust Gas  
While cruising, brief full-throttle acceleration, within the  
limits of local traffic laws, contributes to a good break-in.  
Wide open throttle acceleration in low gear can be  
detrimental and should be avoided.  
WARNING!  
Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain carbon  
monoxide (CO) which is colorless and odorless.  
Breathing it can make you unconscious and can  
eventually poison you. To avoid breathing (CO)  
follow the safety tips below.  
The engine oil installed in the engine at the factory is a  
high quality energy conserving type lubricant. Oil  
changes should be consistent with anticipated climate  
conditions under which vehicle operations will occur.  
The recommended viscosity and quality grades are  
shown in Section 7 of this manual. NON-DETERGENT  
OR STRAIGHT MINERAL OILS MUST NEVER BE  
USED.  
Do not run the engine in a closed garage or in confined  
areas any longer than needed to move your vehicle in or  
out of the area.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
60 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE  
If it is necessary to sit in a parked vehicle with the engine  
running, adjust your heating or cooling controls to force  
outside air into the vehicle. Set the blower at high speed.  
Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a  
collision. Rear seat belt assemblies must be replaced after  
a collision if they have been damaged (bent retractor, torn  
webbing, etc. If there is any question regarding belt or  
retractor condition, replace the belt.  
WARNING!  
Airbag Light  
If you are required to drive with the deck lid/liftgate  
open, make sure that all windows are closed, and the  
climate control blower switch is set at high speed.  
DO NOT use the recirculation mode.  
The light should come on and remain on for 6 to 8  
seconds as a bulb check when the ignition switch is first  
turned ON. If the LED is not lit during starting, have it  
checked. If the light stays on or comes on while driving,  
have the system checked by an authorized dealer.  
Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The  
Vehicle  
Defroster  
Check operation by selecting the defrost mode and place  
the blower control on high speed. You should be able to  
feel the air directed against the windshield.  
Seat Belts  
Inspect the belt system periodically, checking for cuts,  
frays and loose parts. Damaged parts must be replaced  
immediately. Do not disassemble or modify the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 61  
Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make Outside  
The Vehicle  
Fluid Leaks  
Check area under vehicle after overnight parking for fuel,  
engine coolant, oil or other fluid leaks. Also, if gasoline  
fumes are detected or fuel, power steering fluid or brake  
fluid leaks are suspected, the cause should be located and  
corrected immediately.  
Tires  
2
Examine tires for excessive tread wear or uneven wear  
patterns. Check for stones, nails, glass, or other objects  
lodged in the tread. Inspect tread and sidewall for cuts or  
cracks. Check wheel nuts for tightness, and tires (includ-  
ing spare) for proper pressure.  
Lights  
Have someone observe the operation of exterior lights  
while you work the controls. Check turn signal and high  
beam indicator lights on the instrument panel.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
CONTENTS  
3
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67  
Inside Day/ Night Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67  
Outside Mirror—Drivers Side . . . . . . . . . . . . .67  
Outside Mirror—Passengers Side . . . . . . . . . . .68  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72  
Phone Call Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76  
Advanced Phone Connectivity . . . . . . . . . . . . .78  
UConnect™ System Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79  
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82  
Front Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82  
Electric Remote-Control Mirrors — If  
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68  
Illuminated Vanity Mirrors — If Equipped . . . .69  
Sun Visor Sliding Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70  
Drivers Power Seat Height Adjuster — If  
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83  
Hands–Free Communication (UConnect™) — If  
Reclining Bucket Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84  
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
64 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Folding Front Passenger Seat — If Equipped . . .84  
Adjustable Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85  
Heated Seats — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85  
Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86  
Tumbling Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88  
Rear Seat Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90  
To Open And Close The Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92  
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93  
Daytime Running Lights (Canada Only) . . . . . .96  
Lights-On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96  
Fog Lights — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97  
Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97  
Highbeam/ Lowbeam Select Switch . . . . . . . . . .97  
Passing Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97  
Windshield Wipers And Washers . . . . . . . . . . . .98  
Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98  
Mist Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98  
Windshield Wiper Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99  
Intermittent Wiper System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99  
Tilt Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100  
Traction Control Switch — If Equipped . . . . . . . 100  
Overhead Console Map/ Reading Lights — If  
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93  
Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94  
Multi-Function Control Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95  
Headlights, Parking Lights, Instrument Panel  
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 65  
Electronic Speed Control — If Equipped . . . . . . 101  
To Activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102  
To Set At A Desired Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102  
To Deactivate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102  
To Resume Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103  
To Vary The Speed Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103  
Manual Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103  
To Accelerate For Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104  
Overhead Console — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . 104  
Compass/ Temperature Display . . . . . . . . . . . 105  
Automatic Compass Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . 106  
Compass Variance Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106  
Manual Compass Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107  
Outside Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107  
Power Sunroof — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108  
Express Open Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108  
Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109  
Sunroof Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110  
Electrical Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110  
Electrical Outlet Use With Engine Off . . . . . . . 112  
Console Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112  
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
Front Seat Storage Bin — If Equipped . . . . . . . 114  
Storage Pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
Rear Shelf Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
Position 1 (Top) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
66 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Position 2 (Middle) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116  
Position 3 (Floor) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116  
Position 4 (Vertical) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117  
Position 5 (Table) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117  
Roof Luggage Rack — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . 119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 67  
MIRRORS  
Inside Day/Night Mirror  
Adjust the mirror to center on the view through the rear  
window. A two point pivot system allows for horizontal  
and vertical mirror adjustment.  
3
Annoying headlight glare can be reduced by moving the  
small control under the mirror to the night position  
(toward rear of vehicle). The mirror should be adjusted  
while set in the day position (toward windshield).  
Outside Mirror—Driver’s Side  
Adjust the outside mirror to center on the adjacent lane of  
traffic, with a slight overlap of the view obtained on the  
inside mirror.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
68 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Outside Mirror—Passenger’s Side  
Adjust the convex outside mirror so you can just see the  
side of your vehicle in the part of the mirror closest to the  
vehicle.  
Electric Remote-Control Mirrors — If Equipped  
Use the mirror select switch, located to the left of the  
steering column on the instrument panel, to adjust the  
view obtained in the outside mirrors. Press the L or R  
button for Left or Right mirror selection. Use the center  
off position to guard against accidentally moving a  
mirror position.  
WARNING!  
Vehicles and other objects seen in the passenger side  
convex mirror will look smaller and farther away  
than they really are. Relying too much on your  
passenger side mirror could cause you to collide  
with another vehicle or other object. Use your inside  
mirror when judging the size or distance of a vehicle  
seen in this convex mirror.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 69  
Select a mirror and press one of the four arrows for the  
direction you want the mirror to move.  
Illuminated Vanity Mirrors — If Equipped  
An illuminated vanity mirror is on the sun visor. To use  
the mirror, rotate the sun visor down and swing the  
mirror cover upward. The lights turn on automatically.  
Closing the mirror cover turns off the lights.  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
70 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Sun Visor Sliding Feature  
The sun visors may be pulled out to provide extended  
coverage of the side glass.  
The UConnect™; phone book enables you to store up to  
32 names and four numbers per name. This system is  
driven through your Bluetooth™ Hands-Free Profile  
cellular phone. UConnect™ features Bluetooth™ technol-  
ogy - the global standard that enables different electronic  
devices to connect to each other without wires or a  
docking station, so UConnect™ works no matter where  
you stow your cellular phone (be it your purse, pocket, or  
briefcase). UConnect™ allows up to seven cellular  
phones to be linked to the system, and it is available in  
English, French, or Spanish formats (as equipped).  
HANDS–FREE COMMUNICATION (UConnect™) —  
IF EQUIPPED  
UConnect™ is a voice-activated, hands-free, in-vehicle  
communications system. UConnect™; allows you to dial  
your cellular phone using simple voice commands (e.g.,  
“Call Mike Work” or “Dial 248-555-1212”). Your cellular  
phones audio is transmitted through your vehicles  
stereo system; the system will automatically mute your  
radio before receiving or sending a call.  
UConnect™ allows you to transfer calls between the  
system and your cellular phone as you enter or exit your  
vehicle, and enables you to mute the systems micro-  
phone for private conversations.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 71  
The rearview mirror contains the microphone for the  
system and the control buttons that will enable you to  
access the system. The diagram below shows the mirror  
with the appropriate buttons. Individual button behavior  
is discussed in the “Operation” Section.  
The UConnect™ system can be used with any Hands  
Free Profile certified Bluetooth™ cellular phone. If your  
cellular phone has a different profile (i.e. headset profile),  
you will not be able to use any UConnect™ features.  
The UConnect™ system is fully integrated into your  
vehicle, including your vehicles stereo system. All voice  
prompts as well as the other partys voice in a conversa-  
tion will be played over your vehicles stereo system. The  
volume of the UConnect™ system can be controlled  
through your normal stereo controls.  
3
The radio display will be used for visual prompts from  
the UConnect™ system such as caller ID.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
72 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Operation  
complete the registration process, you will need to refer-  
ence your cellular phone owners manual.  
Voice commands can be used in the operation of the  
UConnect™ system and to navigate through the UCon-  
nect™ menu structure. Voice commands should be given  
after each UConnect™ system prompt. You will be  
prompted for a specific command and then guided  
through the available options. There are two ways to give  
commands to the UConnect™ system:  
Press the Phone’ button to begin.  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉSetup Phone PairingЉ.  
You will be asked to say a four-digit pin number into  
the UConnect™ system which you will later need to  
enter into your cellular phone during the cellular  
phone pairing process. You can enter any four-digit  
pin number. You will not need to remember this pin  
number after the initial registration process.  
You can say ЉDialЉ at the ЉReadyЉ prompt. When  
prompted for the phone number you wish to dial, say  
the phone number (Љ123 456 7890Љ).  
Alternatively as you become familiar with the UCon-  
nect™ system, you can combine the commands and  
say ЉDial 123 456 7890Љ.  
The UConnect™ system will then prompt you to begin  
the cellular phone pairing process on your cellular  
phone. Please see your cellular phone users manual  
for instructions on how to complete this step.  
Pairing a Cellular Phone to the UConnect™ System  
To begin using your UConnect™ system, you must pair  
your compatible Bluetooth™ enabled cellular phone. To  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 73  
For identification purposes, you will be prompted to  
give the UConnect™ system a name for your cellular  
phone. Each cellular phone that is paired should be  
given a unique phone name.  
Making a Phone Call Using Digit Dialing  
Press the Phone’ button to begin.  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉDialЉ or ЉCallЉ followed  
by the phone number you wish to dial. For example,  
you can say ЉDial 123 456 7890Љ. The phone number  
that you enter must be a valid length.  
You will then be asked to give your cellular phone a  
priority level between 1 and 7, 1 having the highest  
priority. You can connect up to seven cellular phones  
to your UConnect™ system and the priority allows the  
UConnect™ system to know which cellular phone to  
use if multiple cellular phones are in the vehicle at the  
same time. For example, if a priority 3 and priority 5  
cellular phone are both in the vehicle, the UConnect™  
system will use the priority 3 cellular phone when you  
make a call. You can select to use a lower priority  
cellular phone at any time.  
3
Making a Phone Call Using Your UConnect™  
Phonebook  
Press the “Phone” button to begin.  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉDialЉ or ЉCallЉ followed  
by the name and designation of a phonebook entry  
that you wish to dial. For example, you can say ЉCall  
John Doe WorkЉ.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
74 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Add Names to Your UConnect™ Phonebook  
The UConnect™ system will allow you to enter up to 32  
names into the phonebook with each name having up to  
four associated phone numbers and designations.  
Press the “Phone” button to begin.  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉPhonebook New En-  
tryЉ.  
Edit Entries in the UConnect™ Phonebook  
Press the Phone’ button to begin.  
When prompted, say the name of the new entry.  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉPhonebook EditЉ.  
Next, enter the number designation (e.g. “Home”,  
Work”, “Mobile”, or “Pager”). This will allow you to  
have multiple numbers for each phonebook entry.  
You will then be asked for the name of the phonebook  
entry that you wish to edit.  
Recite the phone number for the phonebook entry that  
you are adding.  
Next, choose the number designation that you wish to  
edit. The choices are home, work, mobile, or pager.  
After you are finished adding an entry into the phone-  
book, you will be given the opportunity to add more  
phone numbers to the current entry or to return to the  
main menu.  
Recite the new phone number for the phonebook entry  
that you are editing.  
After you are finished editing an entry in the phonebook,  
you will be given the opportunities to edit another entry  
in the phonebook, call the number you just edited, or  
return to the main menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 75  
Phonebook edit can be used to add another phone  
number to a name entry that already exists in the  
phonebook. For example, the entry John Doe may have a  
mobile and a home number, but you can add John Does  
work number later through phonebook edit.  
After you enter the name, the UConnect™ system will  
ask you if you wish to delete the home, work, mobile,  
or pager number for this entry.  
Delete All Entries in the UConnect™ Phonebook  
3
Press the Phone’ button to begin.  
Delete Entries in the UConnect™ Phonebook  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉPhonebook Delete AllЉ.  
Press the Phone’ button to begin.  
The UConnect™ system will ask you to verify that you  
wish to delete all the entries from the phonebook.  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉPhonebook DeleteЉ.  
After you enter the phonebook delete menu, you will  
then be asked for the name of the phonebook entry  
that you wish to delete. You can either say the name of  
a phonebook entry that you wish to delete or you can  
say ЉList NamesЉ to hear a list of the entries in the  
phonebook from which you can choose. To select one  
of the entries from the list, press the ЉVoice Recogni-  
tionЉ button while the UConnect™ system is playing  
the desired entry and say ЉDeleteЉ.  
After confirmation, the phonebook entries will be  
deleted.  
List All Names in the UConnect™ Phonebook  
Press the Phone’ button to begin.  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉPhonebook List  
NamesЉ.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
76 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
The UConnect™ system will play the names of all the  
phonebook entries.  
Answer or Reject an Incoming Call - No Call  
Currently in Progress  
When you receive a call on your cellular phone, the  
UConnect™ system will interrupt the stereo audio and  
will ask if you would like to answer the call by pressing  
the Phone’ button. Press the Phone’ button to answer  
the call. To reject the call, press the Phone’ button until  
you hear a single beep indicating that the incoming call  
was rejected.  
To call one of the names in the list, press the Voice  
Recognition’ button during the playing of the desired  
name and say ЉCallЉ.  
The UConnect™ system will then prompt you as to  
number designation you wish to call.  
The selected number will be dialed.  
Answer or Reject an Incoming Call - Call  
Currently in Progress  
Phone Call Features  
The following feature(s) can be accessed through the  
UConnect™ system if the feature(s) are available on your  
cellular service plan. For example, if your cellular service  
plan provides three-way calling, this feature can be  
accessed through the UConnect™ system.  
If a call is currently in progress and you have another  
incoming call, press the Phone’ button to place the  
current call on hold and answer the incoming call. To  
reject the incoming call, you can disregard the call and  
continue with your current conversation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 77  
Making a Second Call while Current Call in  
Progress  
Conference Call  
When two calls are in progress (one active and one on  
hold), press the Phone’ button until you hear a double  
beep indicating that the two calls have been joined into  
one conference call.  
To make a second call while you are currently in a call,  
press the Voice Recognition’ button and say ЉDialЉ or  
ЉCallЉ followed by the phone number or phonebook entry  
you wish to call. The first call will be on hold while the  
second call is in progress.  
3
Three-Way Calling  
To initiate three-way calling, press the Voice Recogni-  
tion’ button while a call is in progress and make a second  
phone call. When the second call is established, press the  
Phone’ button until you hear a double beep indicating  
that the two calls have been joined into one conference  
call.  
Putting a Call on Hold and Retrieving a Call from  
Hold  
To put a call on hold, press the Phone’ button until you  
hear a single beep which will indicate that the call has  
been placed on hold. To bring the call back from hold,  
press the Phone’ button.  
Call Termination  
Toggling Between Two Calls  
To end a call in progress, press the Phone’ button. All  
calls in progress will be terminated.  
If two calls are in progress (one active and one on hold),  
press the Phone’ button until you hear a single beep  
indicating that the active and hold status of the two calls  
have switched. Only one call can be placed on hold at one  
time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
78 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Phone Redial  
Delete Paired Cellular Phones  
Press the Phone’ button to begin.  
Press the Phone’ button to begin.  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉRedialЉ.  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉSetup Phone PairingЉ.  
At the next prompt, say ЉDeleteЉ.  
The UConnect™ system will call the last number that  
was dialed on your cellular phone. This may not be the  
last number dialed by your UConnect™ system.  
You will be asked to say the name of the phone that  
you wish to delete. You can either say the name of the  
phone that you wish to delete or you can say ЉAllЉ to  
delete all the phones.  
Advanced Phone Connectivity  
Transferring an Active Call between the  
UConnect™ System and Your Cellular Phone  
The UConnect™ system allows ongoing calls to be trans-  
ferred to your cellular phone or to the UConnect™  
system without terminating the call. To transfer an ongo-  
ing call from your cellular phone to the UConnect™  
system or vice versa, press the Voice Recognition’ button  
and say ЉTransfer CallЉ.  
Connect or Disconnect the Connection between the  
UConnect™ System and Your Cellular Phone  
Your cellular phone can be paired with many different  
electronic devices, but can only be actively ЉconnectedЉ  
with one electronic device at a time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 79  
If you would like to connect or disconnect the Blue-  
tooth™ connection between a paired cellular phone and  
the UConnect™ system, follow the instruction described  
in your cellular phone users manual.  
UConnect™ system. To select a phone from the list,  
press the Voice Recognition’ button and say ЉSelectЉ.  
The lower priority phone will only be used for the next  
phone call. After that, the UConnect™ system will  
return to using the highest priority phone in the  
vehicle.  
List Paired Cellular Phone Names  
3
Press the Phone’ button to begin.  
UConnect™ System Features  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉSetup List PhonesЉ and  
the UConnect™ system will play the phone names of  
all paired cellular phones in order from highest prior-  
ity to lowest priority.  
Barge In - Touch Tone Phone Inputs  
You can use your UConnect™ system to access a voice  
mail system, an automated service, or any other phone  
number that you can dial with any phone. When calling  
a number with your UConnect™ system that normally  
requires you to enter in a touch-tone sequence on your  
cellular phone keypad, you can push the Voice Recogni-  
tion’ button and say the sequence you wish to enter  
followed by ЉSendЉ. For example, if required to enter your  
pin number, you can press the Voice Recognition’ button  
and say Љ3 7 4 6 SendЉ, or whatever you have made your  
Select a Lower Priority Paired Cellular Phone  
Press the Phone’ button to begin.  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉSetup Select PhoneЉ.  
When prompted, say the phone name of the cellular  
phone you wish to use, or say ЉList PhonesЉ to hear a  
list of all the phones that have been paired to your  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
80 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
pin. This method can also be used in instances where you  
are pressing a number on your keypad to navigate  
through a menu structure or to enter a number for a  
pager.  
Français as equipped). After selecting one of the lan-  
guages, all prompts and voice commands will be in the  
selected language.  
Turning Confirmation Prompts On/Off  
Barge In - Overriding Prompts  
Turning confirmation prompts off will stop the system  
from confirming your choices (e.g. the UConnect™ sys-  
tem will not repeat a phone number before you dial it).  
The Voice Recognition’ button can be used when you  
wish to skip part of a prompt and issue your voice  
recognition command immediately. For example, if a  
prompt is playing ЉWould you like to pair a phone, clear  
aѧЉ, you could press the Voice Recognition’ button and  
say ЉPair A PhoneЉ to select that option without having to  
listen to the rest of the voice prompt.  
Press the Phone’ button to begin.  
After the ЉReadyЉ prompt, say ЉSetup ConfirmationЉ.  
The UConnect™ system will play the current confir-  
mation prompt status and you will be given the choice  
to change it.  
Language Selection  
To change the language that the UConnect™ system is  
using, press the Phone’ button and say the name of the  
language you wish to switch to (English, Español, or  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 81  
Low Signal, Battery Strength, and Roam  
Notification  
The UConnect™ system will provide notification to  
inform you if your cellular phone is in roaming status,  
has low signal strength, or has a low battery when you  
are trying to place a phone call.  
Recognition’ button and say ЉMuteЉ. In order to unmute  
the UConnect™ system; press the Voice Recognition’  
button and say ЉUnmuteЉ.  
Help  
If you need assistance at any prompt or if you want to  
know what your options are at any prompt, say ЉHelpЉ.  
The UConnect™ system will play all the options at any  
prompt if you ask for help.  
3
Dialing Using the Cellular Phone Keypad  
You can dial a phone number with your cellular phone  
keypad and still use the UConnect™ system. By dialing a  
number with your paired Bluetooth™ cellular phone, the  
audio will be played through your vehicles stereo sys-  
tem. The UConnect™ system will work the same as if  
you dialed the number using voice recognition.  
Cancel  
At any prompt, you can say ЉCancelЉ and you will be  
returned to the previous menu.  
Emergency Assistance  
If you are in an emergency, say ЉDial EmergencyЉ or ЉCall  
EmergencyЉ and the UConnect™ system will instruct  
your cellular phone to call 911.  
Mute/Unmute  
When you mute the UConnect™ system, you will still be  
able to hear the conversation coming from the other  
party, but the other party will not be able to hear you. In  
order to mute the UConnect™ system press the Voice  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
82 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Towing Assistance  
If you need towing assistance, say ЉDial Towing Assis-  
tanceЉ or ЉCall Towing AssistanceЉ. Please refer to the  
24-Hour Towing Assistance coverage details in the  
DaimlerChrysler Motors Company 24-Hour Towing As-  
sistance Program Guide.  
SEATS  
Front Seat Adjustment  
The adjusting bar is at the front of the seats, near the  
floor. Pull the bar up to move the seat to the desired  
position.  
Using body pressure, move forward and rearward on the  
seat to be sure the seat adjusters have latched.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 83  
Driver’s Power Seat Height Adjuster — If  
Equipped  
WARNING!  
The power seat height adjuster is on the outboard side of  
the drivers seat. Use this switch to move the seat up or  
down.  
Adjusting a seat while the vehicle is moving is  
dangerous. The sudden movement of the seat  
could cause you to lose control. The seat belt  
might not be properly adjusted and you could be  
injured. Adjust the seat only while the vehicle is  
parked.  
3
Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the  
shoulder belt is no longer resting against your  
chest. In a collision you could slide under the seat  
belt and be seriously or even fatally injured. Use  
the recliner only when the vehicle is parked.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
84 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Reclining Bucket Seats  
Folding Front Passenger Seat — If Equipped  
The passenger front seat may be folded fully forward to  
provide additional cargo space.  
The recliner control is on the outboard side of the seat. To  
recline, lean forward slightly before lifting the lever, then  
lean back to the desired position and release the lever.  
Lean forward and lift the lever to return the seatback to  
its normal position.  
To fold the seat forward pull up on the recliner lever  
located on the outboard side of the seat.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 85  
Adjustable Head Restraints  
Heated Seats — If Equipped  
Head restraints can reduce the risk of whiplash injury in  
the event of impact from the rear. Pull up or push down  
on the head restraints so that the upper edge is as high as  
practical. To raise the head restraint, pull up on the head  
restraint. To lower the head restraint, depress the button  
and push down on the head restraint.  
This feature heats the front drivers and passengers  
seats. The control for the heater is located on the out-  
board side of each seat. After turning on the ignition, you  
may choose from HIGH, or LOW heat settings. An  
indicator on the switch shows which setting has been  
chosen.  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
86 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Press the switch once to select a heat setting (high or low)  
and press the switch a second time in the same direction  
to turn the heated seat off.  
NOTE: Once a heat setting is selected, heat will be felt  
within 2 to 3 minutes.  
Folding Rear Seat  
To provide additional storage area, each rear seatback can  
be folded forward. Push and hold the buttons shown in  
the picture to fold down either or both seatbacks.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 87  
If the seatback is properly latched and the rear center  
lap/ shoulder belt still does not operate properly check  
and see if the Automatic Locking retractor (ALR)  
system is activated.  
WARNING!  
It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,  
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision,  
people riding in these areas are more likely to be  
seriously injured or killed.  
3
WARNING!  
Do not allow people to ride in any area of your  
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat  
belts  
The rear center lap/shoulder belt is equipped with a  
lock-out feature to ensure that the seatback is in the  
fully upright and locked position when occupied. If  
the rear seatback is not fully upright and locked and  
the rear center lap/shoulder belt can be pulled out of  
the retractor, the vehicle should immediately be  
taken to your dealer for service. Failure to follow this  
warning could result in serious or fatal injury.  
Be sure that everyone in your vehicle is in a seat  
and using a seat belt properly.  
NOTE:  
If the rear center lap/ shoulder belt appears to be  
locked into place, check to verify that the seatback is  
fully latched.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
88 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Tumbling Rear Seat  
To provide additional storage in the cargo area, each rear  
seat can be tumbled forward.  
Push and hold the button on the seatback and fold  
down the rear seatback.  
CAUTION!  
It is important that the front seats be pulled forward  
to the midpoint of the seat track to avoid contact  
between the rear seat and the front seatback. If the  
front seat is not pulled forward the two seats will  
make contact during the tumbling motion and cause  
damage to the rear seat material. After the rear seat is  
tumbled forward and secured the front seat can then  
be repositioned to the preferred position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 89  
Pull the release lever located on the outboard side of  
the seat. Lift up the seat and tumble the seat forward.  
3
To return the rear seat to its upright latched position,  
rotate the seat cushion rearward to latch the seat. Then  
lift the seatback to its upright latched position.  
Attach the elastic strap, located at the base of the seat  
cushion, onto the hook bar on the center trim panel to  
hold the seat in place.  
NOTE: The elastic strap should be reinstalled in the clip  
on the base of the seat cushion before returning the seat  
to its normal position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
90 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Rear Seat Removal  
The rear seats can be removed to provide more cargo  
space.  
Pull the release lever located on the outboard side of  
the seat. Lift up the seat and tumble the seat forward.  
Push and hold the button on the seatback and fold  
down the rear seatback.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 91  
Lift up the release levers to disengage the seat from the  
floor attachments.  
NOTE: Small rollers on the bottom of the folded seat  
and a handle at the top allow the seat to be easily moved  
when removed from the vehicle.  
To reinstall the rear seat, insert the seat into the floor  
attachments. Lower the release levers of the seat to latch  
the front floor attachments and rotate the seat rearward  
to latch the seat. Lift the seat back to its upright latched  
position.  
3
WARNING!  
In an accident, you or others in your vehicle could be  
injured if seats are not properly latched to their floor  
attachments. Always be sure the seats are fully  
latched.  
Using the handle on the seat, the seat assembly can  
now be lifted and removed from the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
92 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD  
To open the hood, two latches must be released. First pull  
the hood release lever located under the left side of the  
instrument panel.  
Use the hood prop rod clipped to the drivers side of the  
engine compartment to secure the hood in the open  
position. Place the hood prop at the location stamped into  
the inner hood surface.  
To prevent possible damage, do not slam the hood to  
close it. Lower the hood until it is open approximately 20  
cm (8 inches) and then drop it. This should secure both  
latches. Never drive your vehicle unless the hood is fully  
closed, with both latches engaged.  
WARNING!  
If the hood is not fully latched it could fly up when  
the vehicle is moving and block your forward vision.  
You could have a collision. Be sure all hood latches  
are fully latched before driving.  
Then move the safety catch located under the front edge  
of the hood, near the center and slightly to the right, and  
raise the hood.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 93  
LIGHTS  
Overhead Console Map/Reading Lights — If  
Equipped  
These lights are mounted between the sun visors in the  
overhead console. Each light is turned ON by pressing  
the lens. Press the lens a second time to turn the light  
OFF. The lights also come on when a door is opened or  
the dimmer control is turned fully upward, past the  
second detent.  
3
NOTE: The lights will remain on until the switch is  
pressed a second time, so be sure they have been turned  
off before leaving the vehicle. They will not turn off  
automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
94 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Interior Lights  
The interior lights come on when a door is opened.  
Dome Light Position  
Rotate the dimmer control completely  
upward to the second detent to turn  
on the interior lights. The interior  
lights will remain on when the dim-  
mer control is in this position. With the  
ignition key in the OFF position, the  
interior lights will automatically turn  
off in about 8 minutes if the dimmer  
control is left in the Dome light posi-  
With the ignition key in the OFF position, the interior  
lights will automatically turn off in about 8 minutes if a  
door is left open or the dimmer control is left in the Dome  
light position. Turn the ignition switch ON to restore the  
interior light operation.  
Dimmer Control  
With the parking lights or headlights  
on, rotating the dimmer control for the  
interior lights on the Multi-Function  
Control Lever upward will increase  
the brightness of the instrument panel  
lights.  
tion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 95  
Interior light Defeat (OFF)  
Rotate the dimmer control to the ex-  
Multi-Function Control Lever  
The Multi-Function Control Lever controls the operation  
of the headlights, parking lights, turn signals, headlight  
beam selection, instrument panel light dimming, interior  
lights, the passing lights, and fog lights. The lever is  
located on the left side of the steering column.  
treme bottom “OFF” position. The in-  
terior lights will remain off when the  
doors are open.  
3
Parade Mode (Daytime Brightness Feature)  
Rotate the dimmer control to the first  
detent (white semi-circle). This feature  
brightens the odometer and radio dis-  
play when the parking lights or head-  
lights are on during daylight condi-  
tions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
96 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Headlights, Parking Lights, Instrument Panel  
Lights  
Turn the end of the Multi-Function Control Lever to the  
first detent for parking light operation. Turn to the  
second detent for headlight operation.  
To change the brightness of the instrument panel lights,  
rotate the center portion of the Multi-Function Control  
Lever up or down.  
Daytime Running Lights (Canada Only)  
The front turn signal lights will come on as Daytime  
Running Lights whenever the ignition switch is on, the  
headlights are off, and the parking brake is off. The  
headlight switch must be used for normal night time  
driving.  
Lights-on Reminder  
If the headlights or parking lights are on after the ignition  
is turned OFF, a chime will sound to alert the driver  
when the drivers door is opened.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 97  
Fog Lights — If Equipped  
If either light remains on and does not flash, or there is a  
very fast flash rate, check for a defective outside light  
bulb. If an indicator fails to light when the lever is  
moved, it would suggest that the fuse or indicator bulb is  
defective.  
The front fog light switch is on the Multi-Function  
Control Lever. To activate the front fog lights, turn  
on the parking lights or the low beam headlights  
and pull out the end of the control lever.  
3
NOTE: The fog lights will only operate with the head-  
lights on low beam. Selecting high beam headlights will  
turn off the fog lights.  
Highbeam/Lowbeam Select Switch  
Pull the Multi-Function Control Lever towards you to  
switch the headlights to HIGH beam. Pull the control  
lever a second time to switch the headlights to LOW  
beam.  
Turn Signals  
Move the Multi-Function Control Lever up or down and  
the arrows on each side of the instrument cluster flash to  
show proper operation of the front and rear turn signal  
lights. You can signal a lane change by moving the lever  
partially up or down without moving beyond the detent.  
Passing Light  
You can signal another vehicle with your headlights by  
lightly pulling the Multi-Function Control Lever toward  
you. This will cause the headlights to turn on at high  
beam and remain on until the lever is released.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
98 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS  
The wipers and washers are operated by a switch  
on the control lever. The lever is located on the  
right side of the steering column. Move the con-  
trol lever up to select the desired wiper speed.  
Windshield Washers  
To use the washer, pull the control lever toward you and  
hold while spray is desired. If the lever is pulled while in  
the delay range, the wiper will operate in low speed for  
two wipe cycles after the lever is released, and then  
resume the intermittent interval previously selected.  
If the lever is pulled while in the OFF position, the wipers  
will operate for two wipe cycles, then turn OFF.  
Mist Feature  
Push down on the wiper control lever to activate a single  
wipe to clear the windshield of road mist or spray from  
a passing vehicle. As long as the lever is held down, the  
wipers will continue to operate.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 99  
Intermittent Wiper System  
CAUTION!  
Use the intermittent wiper when weather conditions  
make a single wiping cycle, with a variable pause be-  
tween cycles, desirable. Move the lever to the DEL  
position, then select the delay interval by turning the end  
of the lever. Rotate the knob upward (clockwise) to  
decrease the delay time and downward (counterclock-  
wise) to increase the delay time. The delay can be  
regulated from a maximum of approximately 18 seconds  
between cycles, to a cycle every second.  
In cold weather, always turn off the wiper switch  
and allow the wipers to return to the park position  
before turning off the engine. If the wiper switch is  
left on and the wipers freeze to the windshield,  
damage to the wiper motor may occur when the  
vehicle is restarted.  
3
Windshield Wiper Operation  
Move the lever upward to the second detent for Low  
speed wiper operation, or to the third detent for High  
speed operation  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
100 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
TILT STEERING COLUMN  
WARNING!  
To tilt the column, push down on the lever below the  
multi-function control lever and move the steering wheel  
up or down, as desired. Pull the lever back up to lock the  
column firmly in place.  
Tilting the steering column while the vehicle is  
moving is dangerous. Without a stable steering col-  
umn, you could lose control of the vehicle and have  
an accident. Adjust the column only while the ve-  
hicle is stopped. Be sure it is locked before driving.  
TRACTION CONTROL SWITCH — IF EQUIPPED  
The TRAC indicator, located in the instrument cluster,  
will flash when the Traction Control System is in use.  
The TRAC OFF switch is located on the instrument panel  
below the radio.  
To turn the system OFF, press the TRAC OFF switch until  
the TRAC OFF indicator in the instrument cluster lights  
up.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 101  
NOTE: The Traction Control System will make buzzing  
or clicking sounds when the system is in operation.  
ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL — IF EQUIPPED  
When engaged, this device takes over the accelerator  
operation at speeds greater than 25 mph (40 km/ h). The  
speed control lever is located on the right side of the  
steering wheel.  
3
To turn the system back ON, press the switch a second  
time until the TRAC OFF indicator turns OFF.  
NOTE: The Traction Control System indicator “TRAC  
OFF” will illuminate momentarily as a bulb check, each  
time the ignition switch is turned ON. This will occur  
even if you used the “TRAC OFF” switch to turn the  
system OFF.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
102 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
To Activate:  
To Set At A Desired Speed:  
Push the ON/ OFF button. The CRUISE indicator in the  
instrument cluster will illuminate. To turn the system  
OFF, push the ON/ OFF button a second time. The  
CRUISE indicator will turn off. The system should be  
turned OFF when not in use.  
When the vehicle has reached the desired speed, press  
down on the lever and release. Release the accelerator  
and the vehicle will operate at the selected speed.  
NOTE: The vehicle should be traveling at a steady  
speed and on level ground before pressing the SET lever.  
While in the AutoStick mode, speed control will only  
operate in third and fourth gear.  
WARNING!  
Leaving the Electronic Speed Control system on  
when not in use is dangerous. You could accidentally  
set the system or cause it to go faster than you want.  
You could lose control and have an accident. Always  
leave the system OFF when you are not using it.  
To Deactivate:  
A soft tap on the brake pedal, pulling the speed control  
lever towards you “CANCEL”, or normal brake or clutch  
pressure while slowing the vehicle will deactivate speed  
control without erasing the set speed memory. Pressing  
the ON/ OFF button or turning off the ignition switch  
erases the set speed memory.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 103  
To Resume Speed:  
Tapping the “COAST/ SET” button once will result in a 1  
mph (2 km/ h) speed decrease. Each time the button is  
tapped, speed decreases.  
To resume a previously set speed, push the “ACC/ RES”  
lever up and release. Resume can be used at any speed  
above 20 mph (32 km/ h).  
Manual Transaxle:  
To Vary The Speed Setting:  
Depressing the clutch pedal will disengage the speed  
control. A slight increase in engine RPM before the speed  
control disengages is normal.  
3
When the speed control is ON, speed can be increased by  
pushing up and holding “ACC/ RES”. Release the lever  
when the desired speed is reached, and the new speed  
will be set.  
Vehicles equipped with manual transaxles may need to be  
shifted into a lower gear to climb hills without speed loss.  
Tapping “ACC/ RES” once will result in a 2 mph (3  
km/ h) speed increase. Each time the lever is tapped,  
speed increases so that tapping the lever three times will  
increase speed by 6 mph (10 km/ h), etc.  
WARNING!  
Speed Control can be dangerous where the system  
cant maintain a constant speed. Your vehicle could  
go too fast for the conditions, and you could lose  
control. An accident could be the result. Dont use  
Speed Control in heavy traffic or on roads that are  
winding, icy, snow-covered, or slippery.  
To decrease speed while speed control is ON, push down  
and hold “COAST/ SET”. Release the lever when the  
desired speed is reached, and the new speed will be set.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
104 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
To Accelerate For Passing:  
Depress the accelerator as you would normally. When the  
pedal is released, the vehicle will return to the set speed.  
OVERHEAD CONSOLE — IF EQUIPPED  
This feature has a compass/ temperature display and two  
map lamps. The overhead console is located on the  
headliner between the sun visors.  
Using Speed Control On Hills  
NOTE: The speed control system maintains speed up  
and down hills. A slight speed change on moderate hills  
is normal.  
Vehicles equipped with four speed automatic transaxles  
may experience a downshift to 3rd gear while climbing  
uphill or descending downhill. This downshift to 3rd  
gear is necessary to maintain vehicle set speed.  
On steep hills a greater speed loss or gain may occur so  
it may be preferable to drive without speed control.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 105  
Compass/Temperature Display  
STEP Button Functions:  
This display provides the outside temperature and one of  
eight compass readings to indicate the direction the  
vehicle is facing.  
3
WARNING!  
Even if the display still reads a few degrees above  
32°F ( 0°C), the road surface may be icy, particularly  
in woods or on bridges. Drive carefully under such  
conditions to prevent an accident and possible per-  
sonal injury or property damage.  
1. US  
2. Metric  
3. Off  
4. Magnetic Zone Selection  
5. Manual Compass Calibration  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
106 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Automatic Compass Calibration  
The automatic calibrating feature of the compass elimi-  
nates the need to calibrate the compass due to normal  
varying conditions.  
Compass Variance Selection  
Variance is the difference between magnetic North and  
geographic North. For proper compass function, the  
correct variance zone must be set. Refer to the variance  
map for the correct variance zone. To check the variance  
zone, the ignition switch must be on and the compass/  
temperature displayed. Press and hold the STEP button  
for about 5 to 10 seconds until ZONE and the number  
appears in the display. The number displayed is the  
variance zone used by the compass. To change the zone,  
press the STEP button to scroll through numbers 1  
through 15.  
When the correct variance is selected release the step  
button and the Compass/ Temperature display will re-  
turn to normal after approximately 15 seconds.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 107  
Manual Compass Calibration  
The STEP button must be pressed for 10 to 15 seconds  
to place the compass into CAL mode. Regardless of  
whether the CAL indicator is already illuminated.  
If the compass appears erratic, inaccurate, abnormal or  
the vehicle is new, you may calibrate the compass. Prior  
to calibrating the compass make sure the proper zone is  
selected. Refer to “Magnetic Zone Selection”.Find an  
open area away from large metal objects. With the vehicle  
running, press and hold the STEP button for (about 10 to  
15 seconds). The display will illuminate the CAL indica-  
tor. Drive slowly (about 5 mph) in 3 complete 360 circles.  
The CAL indicator will turn off and the compass will be  
calibrated.  
Outside Temperature  
Because engine temperature can increase the displayed  
temperature, temperature readings are not updated  
when the vehicle is not moving.  
3
If the display shows Ϫ49°F (Ϫ45°C) or 140°F (60°C), see  
your authorized dealer for repair.  
NOTE:  
The compass needs to go through a manual calibration  
to insure proper operation when taking vehicle deliv-  
ery.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
108 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
POWER SUNROOF — IF EQUIPPED  
The power sunroof control is located between the sun  
visors on the overhead console.  
Press and hold the button in the center of the sunroof  
switch to open the vent. The sunroof can be stopped at  
any position between closed and full vent. To close the  
sunroof from the vent position, press and hold the switch  
forward. Releasing the switch will stop the movement of  
the sunroof and the sunroof will remain in the partial  
vent position until the switch is pushed forward again.  
Express Open Feature  
During the Express Open operation, any movement of  
the switch will stop the sunroof and it will remain in a  
partial open position. Again, momentarily pressing the  
switch rearward will activate the Express Open Feature.  
To close the sunroof, hold the switch in the forward  
position. Again, any release of the switch will stop the  
movement and the sunroof will remain in a partial open  
condition until the switch is pushed forward again.  
Press and hold the switch rearward to fully open the  
sunroof. The sunroof can be stopped at any position  
between closed and full open. Momentarily pressing the  
switch rearward will activate the Express Open Feature,  
causing the sunroof to open automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 109  
The sunshade can be opened manually. It will also open  
as the sunroof opens. The sunshade cannot be closed if  
the sunroof is open.  
WARNING!  
In an accident, there is a greater risk of being thrown  
from a vehicle with an open sunroof. You could also  
be seriously injured or killed. Always fasten your  
seat belt properly and make sure all passengers are  
properly secured too.  
WARNING!  
3
Never leave children in a vehicle, with the keys in  
the ignition switch. Occupants, particularly unat-  
tended children, can become entrapped by the  
power sunroof while operating the power sunroof  
switch. Such entrapment may result in serious injury  
or death.  
Do not allow small children to operate the sunroof.  
Never allow fingers or other body parts, or any  
object to project through the sunroof opening. Injury  
may result.  
Wind Buffeting  
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of  
pressure on the ears or a helicopter type sound in the  
ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the  
windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain  
open or partially open positions. This is a normal occur-  
rence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
110 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
the rear windows open, open the front and rear windows  
together to minimize the buffeting. If the buffeting occurs  
with the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to  
minimize the buffeting or open any window.  
Sunroof Maintenance  
Use only a non-abrasive cleaner and a soft cloth to clean  
the glass panel.  
ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETS  
The outlets include tethered caps, labeled with a key  
symbol or battery symbol, indicating power source. All  
outlets are protected by a single 20 Amp fuse.  
It will accept a cigar lighter unit, which is part of the  
optional Smokers Package. To preserve the heating ele-  
ment of the cigar lighter unit, do not hold the lighter in  
the heating position. As a child safety precaution, this  
outlet is powered by the ignition switch, only when the  
switch is in the ЉONЉ or ЉACCESSORYЉ positions.  
The standard outlet in the front of the center floor console  
is a conventional cigar lighter outlet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 111  
There are two optional power outlets. One is in the  
Accessory Switch Bank, in the center of the instrument  
panel.  
The second is in the right rear cargo area.  
3
Since this outlet is remote from the driver, it is powered  
by the ignition switch, only when it is in the ЉONЉ or  
ЉACCESSORYЉ positions, to protect the battery against  
discharge. Note: Neither of the power outlets will accept  
a cigar lighter unit. They are intended only for accessory  
usage.  
This outlet is powered directly by the battery, regardless  
of the ignition switch position. All accessories connected  
to this outlet should be removed or turned off when the  
vehicle is not in use, to protect the battery against  
discharge.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
112 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Electrical Outlet Use With Engine Off  
CONSOLE FEATURES  
The console has two front cup holders, a coin holder, 12  
volt power outlet and a front storage tray. There are  
additional cup holders; one is molded in the center of the  
console to hold large cups and the other is at the rear of  
the console to serve passengers in the rear seat. The floor  
console power outlet will also operate a conventional  
cigar lighter unit (if equipped with an optional Smokers  
Package).  
CAUTION!  
Many accessories that can be plugged in draw  
power from the vehicles battery, even when not  
in use (i.e. cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if  
plugged in long enough, the vehicles battery will  
discharge sufficiently to degrade battery life  
and/or prevent engine starting.  
Accessories that draw higher power (i.e. coolers,  
vacuum cleaners, lights, etc.), will degrade the  
battery even more quickly. Only use these inter-  
mittently and with greater caution.  
After the use of high power draw accessories, or  
long periods of the vehicle not being started (with  
accessories still plugged in), the vehicle must be  
driven a sufficient length of time to allow the  
generator to recharge the vehicles battery.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 113  
CAUTION!  
Many accessories that can be plugged into the 12  
volt power outlet, draw power from the vehicles  
battery, even when not in use; i.e. cellular phones,  
etc. Eventually, if plugged in long enough, the  
vehicles battery will discharge sufficiently to  
degrade battery life and/or prevent engine start-  
ing.  
3
Accessories that draw higher power such as cool-  
ers, vacuum cleaners, lights, etc., will discharge  
the battery even more quickly. Only use these  
intermittently and with greater caution.  
After the use of high power draw accessories, or  
long periods of the vehicle not being started,  
(with accessories still plugged in), the vehicle  
must be driven a sufficient length of time to allow  
the generator to recharge the vehicles battery.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
114 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
STORAGE  
Storage Pockets  
There are also Storage pockets located on each door trim  
panel.  
Front Seat Storage Bin — If Equipped  
REAR SHELF PANEL  
The rear shelf panel attaches to guides in the rear cargo  
area. The rear shelf panel may be installed in one of five  
different positions.  
NOTE: The liftgate may be opened or closed with the  
rear cargo shelf panel in position 1, position 2, position 3  
or position 4.  
The storage bin is located under the front passengers  
seat. To open lift up on the handle and pull the storage  
bin forward.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 115  
WARNING!  
To avoid tipping, lock the shelf securely in all  
positions.  
Do not drive this vehicle with the liftgate open, or  
use the shelf as a seat.  
3
Failure to follow these warnings could result in  
serious or fatal injury.  
Position 1 (Top)  
Insert the front outboard corners of the shelf panel into  
the top guides and slide forward. Press down on the back  
of the shelf panel to lock it into place.  
WARNING!  
Do not load objects on the shelf in position 1 (top).  
In an accident objects could strike occupants causing  
serious or fatal injury.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
116 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
Position 2 (Middle)  
WARNING!  
Insert the front outboard corners of the shelf panel into  
the middle guides and slide forward. Press down on the  
back of the shelf panel to lock it into place.  
Do not load objects over 100 lbs (45 kg) in position 2  
(middle). Failure to follow this warning could cause  
the shelf to collapse resulting in personal injury.  
Position 3 (Floor)  
Insert the front outboard corners of the shelf panel into  
the bottom guides and slide forward.  
NOTE: To carry items that may soil the carpeting, the  
rear shelf panel may be inverted in position 2 or position  
3.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 117  
Position 4 (Vertical)  
WARNING!  
Insert the front outboard corners of the shelf panel into  
the vertical guides behind the rear seatbacks near the  
floor and slide downward. Push the shelf panel forward  
to lock it into place.  
When in the vertical position, the rear shelf panel  
should not be used as a barrier for large objects in  
the cargo area when the seatbacks folded down. In  
an accident objects could strike the seatbacks or  
occupants causing serious or fatal injury.  
3
Position 5 (table)  
With the liftgate open the rear shelf panel can be moved  
rearward to act as a serving counter.  
1. Install the front corners of the shelf panel into the top  
rear guides. Press down on the shelf panel to lock it into  
place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
118 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
2. Twist the knob on the underside of the panel and  
lower the shelf leg.  
WARNING!  
Do not load objects over 100 lbs (45 kg) in position 5  
(table). Failure to follow this warning could cause  
the shelf to collapse resulting in personal injury.  
3. Install the shelf leg into the liftgate latch area as  
labeled on the rear scuff plate.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 119  
ROOF LUGGAGE RACK — IF EQUIPPED  
External racks do not increase the total load carrying  
capacity of the vehicle. Be sure that the total occupant  
and luggage load inside the vehicle, plus the load on the  
luggage rack, do not exceed the rated vehicle capacity.  
The crossbars and siderails are designed to carry the  
weight on vehicles equipped with a luggage rack. The  
load must not exceed 150 lbs (68 kg), and should be  
uniformly distributed over the luggage rack crossbars.  
NOTE: When the luggage rack is not in use, place the  
crossbars together at the rear of the vehicle. In this  
position they are designed to improve the vehicle aero-  
dynamics and reduce wind noise.  
3
Use both adjustable crossbars assemblies to support the  
load and distribute the load as evenly as possible.  
To adjust the crossbars with latch style releases, release  
the latches on the inboard side of the crossbar supports  
on each side of the vehicle, then move the crossbars to the  
desired position. Once the crossbar is in the desired  
position, return both latches to the locked position.  
To adjust the crossbars with botton style releases, depress  
the button and slide the crossbar to the next locking  
position. Alternate sides until the crossbars are posi-  
tioned correctly for your cargo and the stanchions are  
locked square to the slide rails.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
120 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE  
WARNING!  
CAUTION!  
Cargo must be securely tied before driving your  
vehicle. Improperly secured loads can fly off the  
vehicle, particularly at high speeds, resulting in  
personal injury or property damage. Follow the roof  
rack “Cautions” when carrying cargo on your roof  
rack.  
To avoid damage to the roof rack and vehicle, do not  
exceed the maximum roof rack load capacity of 150  
lbs (68 kg). Always distribute heavy loads as evenly  
as possible and secure the load appropriately.  
Long loads which extend over the windshield, such  
as wood panels or surfboards, should be secured to  
both the front and rear of the vehicle.  
Travel at reduced speeds and turn corners carefully  
when carrying large or heavy loads on the roof rack.  
Wind forces, due to natural causes or nearby truck  
traffic, can add sudden upward loads. This is espe-  
cially true on large flat loads and may result in  
damage to the cargo or your vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
CONTENTS  
Instrument Panel Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125  
Two Types Of Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136  
Electrical Disturbances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137  
AM Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137  
FM Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137  
4
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126  
Instrument Cluster—Turbo, With AutoStick . . . . 127  
Instrument Cluster—Turbo, Without AutoStick . . 128  
Instrument Cluster Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . 129  
Electronic Digital Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136  
Clock Setting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136  
Radio General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136  
Radio Broadcast Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136  
Sales Code RAZ—AM/ FM Stereo Radio With  
Cassette Tape Player, CD Player And CD  
Changer Controls — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . 138  
Operating Instructions — Radio . . . . . . . . . . . 138  
Power Switch, Volume Control . . . . . . . . . . . . 138  
Seek Button (Radio Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
122 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138  
PTY (Program Type) Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139  
Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140  
Fade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140  
Tone Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140  
AM/ FM Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141  
Scan Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141  
To Set The Radio Push-Button Memory . . . . . . 141  
To Change From Clock To Radio Mode . . . . . . 142  
Operating Instructions — Tape Player . . . . . . . 142  
Seek Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
Fast Forward (FF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
Rewind (RW) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
Tape Eject . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143  
Scan Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143  
Changing Tape Direction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143  
Metal Tape Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143  
Pinch Roller Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143  
Noise Reduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143  
Operating Instructions — CD Player . . . . . . . . 144  
Inserting The Compact Disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144  
Seek Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145  
EJT CD (Eject) Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145  
FF/ Tune/ RW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145  
Program Button 4 (Random Play) . . . . . . . . . . 145  
Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 123  
Tape CD Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146  
Time Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146  
Scan Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146  
Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154  
CD Player Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157  
Sales Code RB1—AM/ FM Stereo Radio With  
DVD/ GPS Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161  
CD Changer Control Capability — If  
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146  
Satellite Radio — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161  
System Activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161  
4
Sales Code RBK—AM/ FM Stereo Radio With  
CD Player And CD Changer Controls . . . . . . . . 148  
Electronic Serial Number/ Sirius Identification  
Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148  
CD Player Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150  
Number (ENS/ SID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162  
Selecting Satellite Mode In RBB And RBK  
Radios . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162  
CD Changer Control Capability — If  
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152  
Selecting Satellite Mode In RBP, RBU, RAZ,  
And RBQ Radios . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162  
Radio Display Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154  
Selecting a Channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163  
Storing And Selecting Pre-Set Channels . . . . . . 163  
Sales Code RBQ—AM/ FM Stereo Radio With  
6 - Disc CD Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
124 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
Using The PTY (Program Type) Button  
(If Equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166  
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166  
Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171  
Rear Window Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173  
Electric Rear Window Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . 173  
Rear Wiper/ Washer Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174  
Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175  
PTY Button ЉScanЉ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164  
PTY Button ЉSeekЉ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164  
Satellite Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164  
Reception Quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164  
Cassette Tape And Player Maintenance . . . . . . . 165  
CD/ DVD Disc Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166  
Radio Operation And Cellular Phones . . . . . . . . 166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 125  
INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
126 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 127  
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER—TURBO, WITH AUTOSTICK  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
128 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER—TURBO, WITHOUT AUTOSTICK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 129  
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS  
4. Oil Pressure Light  
Shows low engine oil pressure. The light will come  
on and remain on when the ignition switch is  
turned from the OFF to the ON position, and the light  
will turn off after the engine is started. If the bulb does  
not come on during starting, have the system checked by  
an authorized dealer.  
1. Fuel Gauge  
When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the  
pointer will show the level of fuel remaining in the  
fuel tank.  
2. Charging System Light  
4
This light shows the status of the electrical charg-  
ing system. The light should come on briefly when  
the ignition is first turned ON and remain on briefly as a  
bulb check. If the light stays on or comes on while  
driving, it means that there is a problem with the  
charging system. Obtain SERVICE IMMEDIATELY.  
If the light comes on and remains on while driving, stop  
the vehicle and shut off the engine. DO NOT OPERATE  
THE VEHICLE UNTIL THE CAUSE IS CORRECTED.  
The light does not show the quantity of oil in the engine.  
This can be determined using the procedure shown in  
Section 7.  
3. Liftgate Ajar  
This light comes on if the liftgate is not com-  
pletely closed.  
5. Theft Alarm Light — If Equipped  
This light will flash rapidly for several seconds when the  
alarm system is arming. The light will begin to flash  
slowly indicating that the system is armed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
130 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
6. Engine Temperature Warning Light  
If the pointer rises to the H (red) mark, the instrument  
cluster will sound a chime. Pull over and stop the vehicle.  
Idle the vehicle with the air conditioner turned off until  
the pointer drops back into the normal range. If the  
pointer remains on the H (red) mark, turn the engine off  
immediately and call for service.  
This light warns of an overheated engine condi-  
tion. If the engine is critically hot, a warning chime  
will sound 10 times. After the chime turns off, the  
engine will still be critically hot until the light goes out.  
7. Turn Signal Indicators  
The arrows will flash in unison with the exterior  
turn signal, when using the turn signal lever.  
There are steps that you can take to slow down an  
impending overheat condition. If your air conditioning is  
on, turn it off. The air conditioning system adds heat to  
the engine cooling system and turning off the A/ C  
removes this heat. You can also turn the Temperature  
control to maximum heat, the Mode control to Floor and  
the Fan control to High. This allows the heater core to act  
as a supplement to the radiator and aids in removing heat  
from the engine cooling system.  
NOTE: Turn signal bulbs are located in the Instrument  
Panel.  
8. Temperature Gauge  
The temperature gauge shows engine coolant tem-  
perature. Any reading below the red area of the  
gauge shows that the engine cooling system is  
operating properly. The gauge pointer may show a  
higher than normal temperature when driving in hot  
weather, up mountain grades, in heavy stop and go  
traffic, or when towing a trailer.  
9. Speedometer  
Indicates vehicle speed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 131  
10. High Beam Indicator  
This light shows that the headlights are on high  
beam. Pull the turn signal lever toward the steer-  
ing wheel to switch the headlights from high or low  
beam.  
is not functioning and that service is required, however,  
the conventional brake system will continue to operate  
normally provided that the BRAKE warning light is not  
on.  
If the ABS light is on, the brake system should be serviced  
as soon as possible to restore the benefit of Anti-Lock  
Brakes.  
11. Tachometer  
The white area of the scale shows the permissible engine  
revolutions-per-minute (rpm x 1000) for each gear range.  
Before reaching the red area, ease up on the accelerator to  
prevent engine damage.  
4
The warning light should be checked frequently to assure  
that it is operating properly. Turn the ignition key to the  
on position, but do not start the vehicle. The light should  
come on. If the light does not come on, have the system  
checked by an authorized dealer.  
12. Anti-Lock Warning Light (ABS) — If Equipped  
This light monitors the Anti-Lock Brake System  
(ABS) described elsewhere in this manual. This  
light will come on when the ignition key is  
turned to the ON position and may stay on for  
as long as four seconds.  
13. Seat Belt Reminder Light  
When the ignition switch is first turned ON, this  
light will come on for about six seconds. A chime  
will sound if you have not pulled the shoulder belt  
out of the retractor. This is a reminder to “buckle up”. If  
you do not buckle up, the light will remain on.  
If the ABS light remains on or comes on during driving,  
it indicates that the Anti-Lock portion of the brake system  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
132 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
14. Brake System Warning Light  
The operation of the Brake Warning light can be checked  
by turning the ignition key from the OFF to the ON  
position. The light should illuminate for three seconds, or  
until the engine is started, whichever comes first. The  
light should then go out unless the parking brake is  
applied or a brake fault is detected. If the light does not  
illuminate, have the light inspected and serviced as soon  
as possible.  
This light monitors various brake functions,  
including brake fluid level and parking brake  
application. If the brake light comes on, it may  
indicate that the parking brake is applied, or  
there is a low brake fluid level. On vehicles equipped  
with Anti-lock brakes (ABS), it may also indicate an ABS  
malfunction that could lead to reduced braking perfor-  
mance.  
The light will also come on when the parking brake is  
applied with the ignition switch in the ON position.  
WARNING!  
NOTE: This light shows only that the parking brake is  
applied. It does not show the degree of brake application.  
Driving a vehicle with the brake light on is danger-  
ous. A significant decrease in braking performance  
or vehicle stability during braking may occur. It will  
take you longer to stop the vehicle or will make your  
vehicle harder to control. You could have an acci-  
dent. Have the vehicle checked immediately.  
If the parking brake is off and the light remains on, have  
the brake system inspected as soon as possible.  
15. Trac Indicator — If Equipped  
The TRAC Light will come on momentarily as a bulb  
check when the ignition switch is first turned ON.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 133  
The light will flash when the Traction Control System is  
controlling traction.  
18. Trip Indicator  
This vacuum fluorescent display indicator will illuminate  
when the Trip Odometer is in use.  
16. Door Ajar Indicator  
This vacuum fluorescent display indicator illuminates  
the word “DOOR”, when a door is not completely closed.  
If the door is open for more than 8 minutes, the light will  
turn off.  
By pushing the trip button, located next to the instrument  
cluster, the odometer will toggle between total distance  
and trip distance. In the trip odometer mode, holding the  
trip button for more than 2 seconds will reset the trip  
odometer to “0”.  
4
17. Odometer/Trip Odometer  
The odometer shows the total distance the vehicle has  
been driven. The trip odometer shows the trip distance  
since the last reset.  
19. Cruise Indicator — If Equipped  
This indicator shows that the Speed Control  
System is ON.  
U.S. Federal regulations require that upon transfer of  
vehicle ownership, the seller certify to the purchaser the  
correct mileage that the vehicle has been driven. There-  
fore, if the odometer reading changes during repair or  
replacement, be sure to keep a record of the reading  
before and after the service so the correct mileage can be  
determined.  
NOTE: The word “SET” will not illuminate when the  
Speed Control System is on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
134 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
20. Airbag Light  
The system has been automatically deactivated to  
prevent damage to the brake system due to over-  
heated brake temperatures.  
The light comes on and remains on for 6 to 8  
seconds as a bulb check when the ignition switch  
is first turned ON. If the light does not come on  
during starting, stays on, or comes on while driving, have  
the system checked by an authorized dealer.  
NOTE: Extended heavy use of Traction Control may  
cause the system to deactivate and turn on the TRAC  
OFF Light. This is to prevent overheating of the brake  
system and is a normal condition. The system will remain  
disabled for about 4 minutes until the brakes have  
cooled. The system will automatically reactivate and turn  
off the TRAC OFF Light.  
21. Trac Off Light — If Equipped  
The TRAC OFF light will illuminate momentarily as a  
bulb check when the ignition switch is first turned ON. If  
the light does not come on, have the system checked.  
The light will also come on if:  
22. Malfunction Indicator Light  
This light is part of an onboard diagnostic system  
called OBD that monitors emissions, engine, and  
automatic transmission control systems. The light  
will illuminate when the key is in the ON/ RUN position  
before engine start. If the bulb does not come on when  
turning the key from OFF to ON/ RUN, have the condi-  
tion checked promptly.  
The Traction Control switch has been used to turn  
the system off,  
There is an anti-lock system failure,  
There is a Traction Control system failure,  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 135  
Certain conditions such as a loose or missing gas cap,  
poor fuel quality, etc. may illuminate the light after  
engine start. The vehicle should be serviced if the light  
stays on through several of your typical driving cycles. In  
most situations the vehicle will drive normally and will  
not require towing.  
If the fuel level drops to approximately 1.0 gallon (3.75  
Liter), the fuel symbol will flash several times and the  
chime will sound several times.  
25. AutoStick Gear Position— If Equipped  
This vacuum fluorescent display indicator illuminates  
when the gearshift lever is moved to the AutoStick  
position and shows the current gear selection.  
If the Malfunction Indicator Light flashes when the  
engine is running, serious conditions may exist that  
could lead to immediate loss of power or severe catalytic  
converter damage. The vehicle should be serviced as  
soon as possible if this occurs.  
4
26. Fuel Door Reminder  
This symbol is a reminder that the Fuel Filler Door is  
located on the front passengers (right) side of the vehicle.  
27. Odometer/Trip Odometer Reset Knob  
23. Front Fog Light Indicator — If Equipped  
Press the knob to switch between the odometer and trip  
odometer. While the trip odometer is being displayed,  
press and hold this knob for a few seconds to reset the  
trip odometer to zero miles/ kilometers.  
This light shows when the front fog lights are ON.  
24. Low Fuel Light  
When the fuel level drops to about 1/ 8 tank, the  
fuel symbol will light and a single chime will  
sound. The light will remain on until fuel is added.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
136 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
ELECTRONIC DIGITAL CLOCK  
RADIO GENERAL INFORMATION  
The clock and radio each use the display panel built into  
the radio. A digital readout shows the time in hours and  
minutes whenever the ignition switch is in the ON or  
ACC position and the time button is pressed.  
Radio Broadcast Signals  
Your new radio will provide excellent reception under  
most operating conditions. Like any system, however, car  
radios have performance limitations, due to mobile op-  
eration and natural phenomena, which might lead you to  
believe your sound system is malfunctioning. To help  
you understand and save you concern about these “ap-  
parent” malfunctions, you must understand a point or  
two about the transmission and reception of radio sig-  
nals.  
When the ignition switch is in the OFF position, or when  
the radio frequency is being displayed, time keeping is  
accurately maintained.  
Clock Setting Procedure  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON or ACC position  
and press the time button. Using the tip of a ballpoint pen  
or similar object, press either the hour (H) or minute (M)  
buttons on the radio.  
Two Types of Signals  
There are two basic types of radio signals... AM or  
Amplitude Modulation, in which the transmitted sound  
causes the amplitude, or height, of the radio waves to  
vary... and FM or Frequency Modulation, in which the  
frequency of the wave is varied to carry the sound.  
2. Press the H button to set hours or the M button to set  
minutes. The time setting will increase each time you  
press a button.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 137  
Electrical Disturbances  
FM Reception  
Radio waves may pick up electrical disturbances during  
transmission. They mainly affect the wave amplitude,  
and thus remain a part of the AM reception. They  
interfere very little with the frequency variations that  
carry the FM signal.  
Because FM transmission is based on frequency varia-  
tions, interference that consists of amplitude variations  
can be filtered out, leaving the reception relatively clear,  
which is the major feature of FM radio.  
NOTE: On vehicles so equipped the radio, steering  
wheel radio controls and 6 disc CD/ DVD changer if  
equipped, will remain active for up to 45 seconds after  
the ignition switch has been turned off. Opening a  
vehicle front door will cancel this feature.  
AM Reception  
4
AM sound is based on wave amplitude, so AM reception  
can be disrupted by such things as lightning, power lines  
and neon signs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
138 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
SALES CODE RAZ—AM/ FM STEREO RADIO  
WITH CASSETTE TAPE PLAYER, CD PLAYER  
AND CD CHANGER CONTROLS — IF EQUIPPED  
Power Switch, Volume Control  
Press the ON/ VOL control to turn the radio on. Turn the  
volume control clockwise to increase the volume. The  
volume will be displayed and continuously updated  
while the button is pressed.  
Seek Button (Radio Mode)  
Press and release the Seek button to search for the next  
station in either the AM or FM mode. Press the top of the  
button to seek up and the bottom to seek down. Holding  
the button will by pass stations until you release the  
button.  
Tuning  
Operating Instructions — Radio  
Press the TUNE control up or down to increase or  
decrease the frequency. If you press and hold the button,  
the radio will continue to tune until you release the  
button. The frequency will be displayed and continu-  
ously updated while the button is pressed.  
NOTE: Power to operate the radio is controlled by the  
ignition switch. It must be in the ON or ACC position to  
operate the radio.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 139  
PTY (Program Type) Button  
Program Type  
Radio Display  
Pressing this button once will turn on the PTY mode for  
5 seconds. If no action is taken during the 5 second time  
out the PTY icon will turn off. Pressing the PTY button  
within 5 seconds will allow the program format type to  
be selected. Many radio stations do not currently broad-  
cast PTY information.  
News  
News  
Nostalgia  
Oldies  
Nostalga  
Oldies  
Persnlty  
Public  
Personality  
Public  
4
Rhythm and Blues  
Religious Music  
Religious Talk  
Rock  
R & B  
Toggle the PTY button to select the following format types:  
Rel Musc  
Rel Talk  
Rock  
Program Type  
Adult Hits  
Radio Display  
Adlt Hit  
Classical  
Classicl  
Cls Rock  
College  
Country  
Inform  
Soft  
Soft  
Classic Rock  
College  
Soft Rock  
Soft Rhythm and Blues  
Sports  
Soft Rck  
Soft R&B  
Sports  
Country  
Information  
Jazz  
Talk  
Talk  
Jazz  
Top 40  
Top 40  
Weather  
Foreign Language  
Language  
Weather  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
140 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
By pressing the SEEK button when the PTY icon is  
displayed, the radio will be tuned to the next frequency  
station with the same selected PTY name. The PTY  
function only operates when in the FM mode.  
Balance  
The Balance control adjusts the left-to-right speaker bal-  
ance. Push in the button and it will pop out. Adjust the  
balance and push the button back in. The balance will be  
displayed and continuously updated while the button is  
turned.  
The radio display will flash “SEEK” and the selected PTY  
program type when searching for the next PTY station. If  
no station is found with the selected PTY program type,  
the radio will return to the last preset station.  
Fade  
The Fade control provides for balance between the front  
and rear speakers. Push in the button and it will pop out.  
Adjust the balance and push the button back in. The fade  
will be displayed and continuously updated while the  
button is turned.  
If a preset button is activated while in the PTY (Program  
Type) mode, the PTY mode will be exited and the radio  
will tune to the preset station.  
Pressing PTY, then SCAN will scan the FM Band and stop  
at all RDS stations. Each RDS station will be played for a  
5 second scan once around the FM Band and stop at the  
last station. The PTY icon will then turn off.  
Tone Control  
Slide the Bass and/ or Treble controls up or down to  
adjust the sound for the desired tone. The treble, and bass  
will be displayed and continuously updated while the  
slide is moved.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 141  
AM/FM Selection  
To Set The Radio Push-button Memory  
Press the AM/ FM button to change from AM to FM. The  
operating mode will be displayed next to the station  
frequency. The display will show ST when a stereo  
station is received.  
When you are receiving a station that you wish to  
commit to push-button memory, press the SET button.  
SET 1 will show in the display window. Select the  
push-button you wish to lock onto this station and press  
and release that button. If a station is not selected within  
5 seconds after pressing the SET button, the station will  
continue to play but will not be locked into push-button  
memory.  
Scan Button  
Pressing the SCAN button causes the tuner to search for  
the next station, in either AM or FM, pausing for 5  
seconds at each listenable station before continuing to the  
next.  
4
You may add a second station to each push-button by  
repeating the above procedure with this exception: Press  
the SET button twice and SET 2 will show in the display  
window. Each button can be set for SET 1 and SET 2 in  
both AM and FM. This allows a total of 10 AM and 10 FM  
stations to be locked into memory. You can recall the  
stations stored in SET 2 memory by pressing the push-  
button twice.  
Pressing the AM/ FM button continues the search in the  
alternate frequency band.  
To stop the search, press SCAN a second time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
142 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
To Change From Clock To Radio Mode  
Press the Time button to change the display between  
radio frequency and time.  
Press the SEEK button up or down to move the track  
number to skip forward or backward 1 to 6 selections.  
Press the SEEK button once to move 1 selection, twice to  
move 2 selections, etc.  
Operating Instructions — Tape Player  
Insert the cassette with the exposed tape side toward the  
right and the mechanical action of the player will gently  
pull the cassette into the play position.  
Fast Forward (FF)  
Press the FF button up momentarily to advance the tape  
in the direction that it is playing. The tape will advance  
until the button is pressed again or the end of the tape is  
reached. At the end of the tape, the tape will play in the  
opposite direction.  
NOTE: When subjected to extremely cold temperatures,  
the tape mechanism may require a few minutes to warm  
up for proper operation. Sometimes poor playback may  
be experienced due to a defective cassette tape. Clean and  
demagnetize the tape heads at least twice a year.  
Rewind (RW)  
Press the RW button momentarily to reverse the tape  
direction. The tape will reverse until the button is pressed  
again or until the end of the tape is reached. At the end of  
the tape, the tape will play in the opposite direction.  
Seek Button  
Press the SEEK button up for the next selection on the  
tape and down to return to the beginning of the current  
selection.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 143  
Tape Eject  
Pinch Roller Release  
Press the EJT Tape button and the cassette will disengage  
and eject from the radio.  
If ignition power or the radio ON/ OFF switch are turned  
off, the pinch roller will automatically retract to protect  
the tape from any damage. When power is restored to the  
tape player, the pinch roller will automatically reengage  
and the tape will resume play.  
Scan Button  
Press this button to play 10 seconds of each selection.  
Press the scan button a second time to cancel the feature.  
Noise Reduction  
The Dolby Noise Reduction System* is on whenever the  
tape player is on, but may be switched off.  
4
Changing Tape Direction  
If you wish to change the direction of tape travel (side  
being played), press the PTY button. The lighted arrow in  
the display window will show the new direction.  
To turn off the Dolby Noise reduction System: Press the  
Dolby button (button 2) after you insert the tape. The NR  
light in the display will go off when the Dolby System is  
off. The Dolby System is automatically reactivated each  
time a tape is inserted.  
Metal Tape Selection  
If a standard metal tape is inserted into the player, the  
player will automatically select the correct equalization  
and the 70 symbol will appear in the display window.  
* ”Dolby” noise reduction manufactured under license  
from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation. Dolby  
and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Labo-  
ratories Licensing Corporation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
144 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
Operating Instructions — CD Player  
If the volume control is ON, the unit will switch from  
radio to CD mode and begin to play. The display will  
show the track number and index time in minutes and  
seconds. Play will begin at the start of track one.  
NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC  
position and the volume control ON before the CD player  
will operate.  
NOTE:  
You may eject a disc with the radio OFF. The ignition  
switch must be in the ON or ACC position to insert a  
disc with the radio OFF.  
CAUTION!  
3
This CD player will accept 4 4 inch (12 cm) discs  
only. The use of other sized discs may damage the  
CD player mechanism.  
If you insert a disc with the ignition ON and the radio  
OFF, the CD will automatically be pulled into the CD  
Player and the display will show the time of day. If  
you insert a disc with the ignition OFF, the display will  
show the time of day for about 5 seconds, then go out.  
Inserting The Compact Disc  
The CD player contained within the radio is not a  
multi-disc changer, and will only accept one CD. Gently  
insert one CD into the CD player with the CD label facing  
up. The CD will automatically be pulled into the CD  
Player.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 145  
Seek Button  
FF/TUNE/RW  
Press the top of the SEEK button for the next selection on  
the CD. Press the bottom of the button to return to the  
beginning of the current selection, or return to the  
beginning of the previous selection if the CD is within the  
first 10 seconds of the current selection.  
Press FF (Fast Forward) and the CD player will begin to  
fast forward until FF is released. The RW ( Reverse)  
button works in a similar manner.  
Program Button 4 (Random Play)  
Press this button while the CD is playing to activate  
Random Play. This feature plays the tracks on the se-  
lected disc in random order to provide an interesting  
change of pace.  
EJT CD (Eject) Button  
4
Press this button and the disc will unload and move to  
the entrance for easy removal. The unit will switch to the  
radio mode.  
Press the SEEK button to move to the next randomly  
selected track.  
If you do not remove the disc within 15 seconds, it will be  
reloaded. The radio mode will continue to appear.  
Press TUNE FF to fast forward through the tracks. Press  
the FF button a second time to stop the fast forward  
feature. If TUNE RW is pressed, the current track will  
reverse to the beginning of the track and begin playing.  
The disc can be ejected with the radio OFF.  
Press button 4 a second time to stop Random Play.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
146 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
MODE  
Time Button  
Press the MODE button to select between the tape player,  
CD player, or satellite radio (if equipped).  
Press this button to change the display from elapsed CD  
playing time to time of day.  
To select Satellite Radio (if equipped), press the MODE  
button until the word SIRIUS appears. The following will  
be displayed in this order: After three seconds, the  
current channel name and number will be displayed for  
five seconds. The current program type and channel  
number will then be displayed for five seconds. The  
current channel name and number will then be displayed  
until an action occurs. A CD or tape may remain in the  
player while in the Satellite Radio mode.  
Scan Button  
Press this button to play the first 10 seconds of each track.  
To stop the scan function, press the button a second time.  
CD Changer Control Capability — If Equipped  
This radio is compatible with a remote mounted CD  
changer available through Mopar Accessories. The fol-  
lowing instructions are for the radio controls that operate  
this CD changer.  
Mode Button  
To activate the CD changer, press the MODE button until  
CD information appears on the display.  
Tape CD Button  
Press this button to select between CD player and Tape  
player.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 147  
Push-Button  
CD Diagnostic Indicators  
While the CD changer is playing, press the NUMBER 1  
push-button or the NUMBER 5 push-button to select a  
disc numbered higher or lower than the one currently  
being played.  
When driving over a very rough road, the CD player may  
skip momentarily. Skipping will not damage the disc or  
the player, and play will resume automatically.  
As a safeguard and to protect your CD player, one of the  
following warning symbols may appear on your display.  
Seek Button  
Press the SEEK up or down to select another track on the  
same disc. A SEEK symbol will appear on the display.  
4
A CD HOT symbol indicates the player is too hot.  
CD HOT will pause the operation. Play can be resumed  
when the operating temperature is corrected or another  
MODE is selected.  
Fast Forward And Rewind Buttons  
Press and hold the FF button for fast forward. Press and  
hold the RW button for fast reverse.  
An ERR symbol will appear on the display if the laser is  
unable to read the Disc data for the following reasons:  
The audio output can be heard when fast forward and  
fast reverse are activated.  
Random Play (RND)  
Press the Random button to play the tracks on the selected  
disc in random order for an interesting change of pace.  
Excessive vibration  
Disc inserted upside down  
Damaged disc  
Random can be cancelled by pressing the button a second  
time or by ejecting the CD from the changer.  
Water condensation on optics  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
148 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
SALES CODE RBK—AM/ FM STEREO RADIO  
WITH CD PLAYER AND CD CHANGER  
CONTROLS  
Radio Operation  
Power/Volume Control  
Press the ON/ VOL control to turn the radio on. Turn the  
volume control clockwise to increase the volume.  
NOTE: Power to operate the radio is supplied through  
the ignition switch. It must be in the ON or ACC position  
to operate the radio.  
Seek  
Press and release the SEEK button to search for the next  
station in either the AM or FM mode. Press the top of the  
button to seek up and the bottom to seek down. The  
radio will remain tuned to the new station until you  
make another selection. Holding the button in will by-  
pass stations without stopping until you release it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 149  
Tune  
the mid-position. Moving the control up or down in-  
creases or decreases amplification of that band. The mid  
position provides a balanced output.  
Press the TUNE control up or down to increase or  
decrease the frequency. If you press and hold the button,  
the radio will continue to tune until you release the  
button. The frequency will be displayed and continu-  
ously updated while the button is pressed.  
AM/FM Selection  
Press the AM/ FM button to change from AM to FM. The  
operating mode will be displayed next to the station  
frequency. The display will show ST when a stereo  
station is received.  
Balance  
4
The Balance control adjusts the left-to-right speaker bal-  
ance. Press the BAL button in and it will pop out. Adjust  
the balance and push the button back in.  
To Set The Radio Push-Button Memory  
When you are receiving a station that you wish to  
commit to push-button memory, press the SET button.  
SET 1 will show in the display window. Select the “1–5”  
button you wish to lock onto this station and press and  
release that button. If a button is not selected within 5  
seconds after pressing the SET button, the station will  
continue to play but will not be locked into push-button  
memory.  
Fade  
The Fade control provides for balance between the front  
and rear speakers. Press the FADE button in and it will  
pop out. Adjust the balance and push the button back in.  
Bass and Treble Tone Control  
The tone controls consist of 2 separate bands. The bass  
band is on the left, and the treble band is on the right.  
Each band is adjusted by a slider control with a detent at  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
150 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
You may add a second station to each push-button by  
repeating the above procedure with this exception: Press  
the SET button twice and SET 2 will show in the display  
window. Each button can be set for SET 1 and SET 2 in  
both AM and FM. This allows a total of 10 AM and 10 FM  
stations to be locked into push-button memory. The  
stations stored in SET 2 memory can be selected by  
pressing the push-button twice. Every time a preset  
button is used a corresponding button number will be  
displayed.  
1. This device may not cause harmful interference,  
2. This device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired opera-  
tion.  
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressively ap-  
proved by the party responsible for compliance could  
void the users authority to operate the equipment.  
CD Player Operation  
NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC  
position and the volume control ON before the CD player  
will operate.  
Time  
Press the TIME button to change the display between  
radio frequency and time.  
General Information  
This radio complies with Part 15 of FCC rules and with  
RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the  
following conditions:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 151  
Inserting The Compact Disc  
CAUTION!  
Seek  
Press the top of the SEEK button for the next selection on  
the CD. Press the bottom of the button to return to the  
beginning of the current selection, or return to the  
beginning of the previous selection if the CD is within the  
first second of the current selection.  
3
This CD player will accept 4 4 inch (12 cm) discs  
only. The use of other sized discs may damage the  
CD player mechanism.  
EJT — Eject  
4
Press the EJT button and the disc will unload and move  
to the entrance for easy removal. The unit will switch to  
the radio mode.  
You may either insert or eject a disc with the radio OFF.  
If you insert a disc with the ignition ON and the radio  
OFF, the display will show the time of day.  
If you do not remove the disc within 15 seconds, it will be  
reloaded. The unit will continue in radio mode.  
If the power is ON, the unit will switch from radio to CD  
mode and begin to play when you insert the disc. The  
display will show the track number and index time in  
minutes and seconds. Play will begin at the start of track  
one.  
The disc can be ejected with the radio and ignition OFF.  
FF/TUNE/RW  
Press FF (Fast Forward) and the CD player will begin to  
fast forward until FF is released. The RW ( Reverse)  
button works in a similar manner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
152 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
Random Play — RND/Program Button 4  
Press the RND (button 4) button while the CD is playing  
to activate Random Play. This feature plays the tracks on  
the selected disc in random order to provide an interest-  
ing change of pace.  
Time  
Press the TIME button to change the display from  
elapsed CD playing time to time of day.  
CD Changer Control Capability — If Equipped  
This radio is compatible with a remote mounted CD  
changer available through Mopar Accessories. The fol-  
lowing instructions are for the radio controls that operate  
this CD changer.  
Press the SEEK button to move to the next randomly  
selected track.  
Press the RND (button 4) button a second time to stop  
Random Play.  
Mode Button  
To activate the CD changer, press the MODE button until  
CD information appears on the display.  
Mode  
Press the MODE button repeatedly to select between the  
CD player, the optional remote CD changer and the  
Satellite Radio (if equipped). When Satellite Radio (if  
equipped) is selected “SA” will appear in your radio  
display.  
Push-Button  
While the CD changer is playing, press the NUMBER 1  
push-button or the NUMBER 5 push-button to select a  
disc numbered higher or lower than the one currently  
being played.  
A CD or tape may remain in the player while in the  
Satellite mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 153  
Seek Button  
CD Diagnostic Indicators  
Press the SEEK up or down to select another track on the  
same disc. A SEEK symbol will appear on the display.  
When driving over a very rough road, the CD player may  
skip momentarily. Skipping will not damage the disc or  
the player, and play will resume automatically.  
Fast Forward And Rewind Buttons  
Press and hold the FF button for fast forward. Press and  
hold the RW button for fast reverse.  
As a safeguard and to protect your CD player, one of the  
following warning symbols may appear on your display.  
4
The audio output can be heard when fast forward and  
fast reverse are activated.  
A CD HOT symbol indicates the player is too hot.  
CD HOT will pause the operation. Play can be resumed  
when the operating temperature is corrected or another  
MODE is selected.  
Random Play (RND)  
Press the Random button to play the tracks on the  
selected disc in random order for an interesting change of  
pace.  
An ERR symbol will appear on the display if the laser is  
unable to read the Disc data for the following reasons:  
Random can be cancelled by pressing the button a second  
time or by ejecting the CD from the changer.  
Excessive vibration  
Disc inserted upside down  
Damaged disc  
Water condensation on optics  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
154 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
Radio Display Messages  
Your radio has been designed to display certain messages  
when a problem is detected with the CD player.  
SALES CODE RBQ—AM/FM STEREO RADIO  
WITH 6 - DISC CD CHANGER  
Radio Operation  
Power/Volume Control  
Press the PWR/ VOL control to turn the radio on. Turn  
the volume control clockwise to increase the volume.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 155  
NOTE: Power to operate the radio is controlled by the  
ignition switch. It must be in the ON or ACC position to  
operate the radio.  
Seek  
Press and release the SEEK button to search for the next  
station in either the AM or FM mode. Press the top of the  
button to seek up and the bottom to seek down. The  
radio will remain tuned to the new station until you  
make another selection. Holding the button in will by-  
pass stations without stopping until you release it.  
Mode  
Press the MODE button repeatedly to select between AM,  
FM, the CD changer and Sirius Satellite Radio™ (if  
equipped). The display will show ST when a stereo  
station is received.  
4
Tune  
Press the TUNE control up or down to increase or  
decrease the frequency. If the button is pressed and held,  
the radio will continue to tune until the button is  
released. The frequency will be displayed and continu-  
ously updated while the button is pressed.  
To select Sirius Satellite Radio™ (if equipped), press the  
MODE button until the word SIRIUS appears. The fol-  
lowing will be displayed in this order: After three sec-  
onds, the current channel name and number will be  
displayed for five seconds. The current program type and  
channel number will then be displayed for five seconds.  
The current channel name and number will then be  
displayed until an action occurs. CDs may remain in the  
player while in the Satellite Radio mode.  
Balance — BAL  
The Balance control adjusts the left-to-right speaker bal-  
ance. Press the BAL button in and it will pop out. Adjust  
the balance and push the button back in.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
156 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
Fade  
5 seconds after pressing the SET RND button, the station  
will continue to play but will not be locked into push-  
button memory.  
The Fade control provides for balance between the front  
and rear speakers. Press the FADE button in and it will  
pop out. Adjust the balance and push the button back in.  
You may add a second station to each push-button by  
repeating the above procedure with this exception: Press  
the SET button twice and SET 2 will show in the display  
window. Each button can be set for SET 1 and SET 2 in  
both AM and FM. This allows a total of 12 AM and 12 FM  
stations to be locked into push-button memory. The  
stations stored in SET 2 memory can be selected by  
pressing the corresponding push-button twice. Every  
time a preset button is used, a corresponding button  
number will be displayed.  
Tone Control  
The tone controls affect the Bass and Treble frequency  
bands. Each is controlled by a slider control with a detent  
at the mid position. Moving a control up or down  
increases or decreases amplification of the band. The mid  
position provides a balanced output.  
To Set The Radio Push-Button Memory  
When you are receiving a station that you wish to  
commit to push-button memory, press the SET RND  
button. SET 1 will show in the display window. Select the  
“1–6” button you wish to lock onto this station and press  
and release that button. If a button is not selected within  
Time Button  
Press the TIME button to change the display between  
radio frequency and time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 157  
General Information  
Inserting The Compact Disc  
This radio complies with Part 15 of FCC rules and with  
RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the  
following conditions:  
CAUTION!  
3
This CD player will accept 4 4 inch (12 cm) discs  
1. This device may not cause harmful interference,  
only. The use of other sized discs may damage the  
CD player mechanism.  
2. This device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired opera-  
tion.  
4
You may either insert or eject a disc with the radio OFF.  
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressively ap-  
proved by the party responsible for compliance could  
void the users authority to operate the equipment.  
If you insert a disc with the ignition ON and the radio  
OFF, the display will show the time of day. If you insert  
a disc with the ignition OFF, the display will show the  
time of day for about 5 seconds, then go out.  
CD Player Operation  
NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACC  
position and the Power / Volume control pushed ON  
before the CD player will operate.  
If you insert a disc with the ignition ON and the radio  
ON, the unit will switch from radio to CD mode and  
begin to play when you insert the disc. The display will  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
158 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
show the disc number, the track number, and index time  
in minutes and seconds. Play will begin at the start of  
track 1.  
If you have ejected a disc and have not removed it within  
15 seconds, it will be reloaded. If the CD is not removed,  
the radio will continue to play the non-removed CD. If  
the CD is removed and there are other CDs in the radio,  
the radio will play the next CD. If the CD is removed and  
there are no other CDs in the radio, the radio will return  
to the last selected AM or FM mode.  
LOAD/ EJT — Load  
Press the LOAD/ EJT button and the button with the  
corresponding number where the CD is being loaded.  
After the radio displays “load” insert the CD into the  
player.  
The disc can be ejected with the radio and ignition OFF.  
Radio display will show “loading” when it is being  
loaded.  
Seek  
Press the top of the SEEK button for the next selection on  
the CD. Press the bottom of the button to return to the  
beginning of the current selection, or return to the  
beginning of the previous selection if the CD is within the  
first second of the current selection.  
LOAD / EJT — Eject  
Press the LOAD/ EJT button and the button with the  
corresponding number where the CD was loaded and the  
disc will unload and move to the entrance for easy  
removal.  
Scan  
Press the Scan button to scan through each track on the  
CD currently playing.  
Radio display will show “ejecting” when it is being  
ejected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 159  
FF/TUNE/RW  
PTY (Program Type) Button  
Press FF (Fast Forward) and the CD player will begin to  
fast forward until FF is released. The RW ( Reverse)  
button works in a similar manner.  
Pressing this button once will turn on the PTY mode for  
5 seconds. If no action is taken during the 5 second time  
out the PTY icon will turn off. Pressing the PTY button  
within 5 seconds will allow the program format type to  
be selected. Many radio stations do not currently broad-  
cast PTY information.  
Random Play — SET / RND  
Press the RND button while the CD is playing to activate  
Random Play. This feature plays the tracks on the disc in  
random order to provide an interesting change of pace.  
4
Toggle the PTY button to select the following format types:  
Program Type  
Adult Hits  
Radio Display  
Adlt Hit  
Press the SEEK button to move to the next randomly  
selected track.  
Classical  
Classic Rock  
College  
Classicl  
Cls Rock  
College  
Country  
ALERT!  
Test  
Press TUNE FF to fast forward through the tracks. Press  
the FF button a second time to stop the fast forward  
feature. If TUNE RW is pressed, the current track will  
reverse to the beginning of the track and begin playing.  
Country  
Emergency  
Emergency Test  
Information  
Jazz  
Press the SET / RND button a second time to stop  
Random Play.  
Inform  
Jazz  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
160 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
By pressing the SEEK button when the PTY icon is  
displayed, the radio will be tuned to the next frequency  
station with the same selected PTY name. The PTY  
function only operates when in the FM mode.  
Program Type  
Foreign Language  
News  
Nostalgia  
Oldies  
Personality  
Public  
Rhythm and Blues  
Religious Music  
Religious Talk  
Rock  
Radio Display  
Language  
News  
Nostalga  
Oldies  
Persnlty  
Public  
The radio display will flash “SEEK” and the selected PTY  
program type when searching for the next PTY station. If  
no station is found with the selected PTY program type,  
the radio will return to the last station.  
R & B  
Rel Musc  
Rel Talk  
Rock  
If a preset button is activated while in the PTY (Program  
Type) mode, the PTY mode will be exited and the radio  
will tune to the preset station.  
Soft  
Soft Rock  
Soft Rhythm and Blues  
Sports  
Talk  
Soft  
By pressing the SCAN button when the PTY icon is  
displayed, the radio will stop at every PTY station on the  
band and list each corresponding program type in the  
radio display.  
Soft Rck  
Soft R&B  
Sports  
Talk  
Top 40  
Weather  
Time  
Top 40  
Weather  
Press the TIME button to change the display from  
elapsed CD playing time to time of day.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 161  
SALES CODE RB1—AM/FM STEREO RADIO  
WITH DVD/GPS NAVIGATION SYSTEM  
SATELLITE RADIO — IF EQUIPPED  
Satellite radio uses direct satellite to receiver broadcast-  
ing technology to provide clear digital sound, coast to  
coast. The subscription service provider is Sirius™ Satel-  
lite Radio. This service offers up to 100 channels of music,  
sports, news, entertainment, and programming for chil-  
dren, directly from its satellites and broadcasting studios.  
4
System Activation  
To activate your Sirius Satellite Radio service, call the  
toll-free number 888-539-7474, or visit the Sirius web site  
at www.sirius.com. Please have the following informa-  
tion available when activating your system:  
1. The Electronic Serial Number/ Sirius Identification  
Number (ESN/ SID).  
The navigation system provides maps, turn identifica-  
tion, selection menus and instructions for selecting a  
variety of destinations and routes. Refer to your “Navi-  
gation Users Manual” for detailed operating instruc-  
tions.  
2. Credit card information.  
3. Your Vehicle Identification Number.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
162 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
Electronic Serial Number/Sirius Identification  
Number (ENS/SID)  
ESN/SID Access With RBP, RBU, RAZ, and RBQ  
Radios  
The Electronic Serial Number/ Sirius Identification Num-  
ber is needed to activate your Sirius Satellite Radio  
system. To access the ESN/ SID, refer to the following  
steps:  
With the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY position and  
the radio OFF, press the CD Eject and TIME buttons  
simultaneously for 3 seconds. All twelve ESN/ SID num-  
bers will be displayed. The radio will exit the ESN/ SID  
mode when any other button is pushed, the ignition is  
turned OFF, or 5 minutes has passed since any button  
was pushed.  
ESN/SID Access With RBB and RBK Radios  
With the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY position and  
the radio OFF, press the Tape Eject or CD Eject (depend-  
ing on the radio type) and Time buttons simultaneously  
for 3 seconds. The first four digits of the twelve-digit  
ESN/ SID number will be displayed. Press the SEEK UP  
button to display the next four digits. Continue to press  
the SEEK UP button until all twelve ESN/ SID digits have  
been displayed. The SEEK DOWN will page down until  
the first four digits are displayed. The radio will exit the  
ESN/ SID mode when any other button is pushed, the  
ignition is turned OFF, or 5 minutes has passed since any  
button was pushed.  
Selecting Satellite Mode in RBB and RBK Radios  
Press the MODE button repeatedly until ЉS AЉ appears in  
the display. A CD or tape may remain in the radio while  
in the Satellite radio mode.  
Selecting Satellite Mode in RBP, RBU, RAZ, and  
RBQ Radios  
Press the MODE button repeatedly until the word  
ЉSIRIUSЉ appears in the display. These radios will also  
display the following:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 163  
After 3 seconds, the current channel name and channel  
number will be displayed for 5 seconds.  
Press and release the SCAN button (if equipped) to  
automatically change channels every 7 seconds. The  
radio will pause on each channel for 7 seconds before  
moving on to the next channel. The word ЉSCANЉ will  
appear in the display between each channel change. Press  
the SCAN button a second time to stop the search.  
The current program type and channel number will  
then be displayed for 5 seconds.  
The current channel number will then be displayed  
until an action occurs.  
NOTE: Channels that may contain objectionable content  
can be blocked. Contact Sirius Customer Care at 888-539-  
7474 to discuss options for channel blocking or unblock-  
ing. Please have your ESN/ SID information available.  
4
A CD or tape may remain in the radio while in the  
Satellite radio mode.  
Selecting a Channel  
Press and release the SEEK or TUNE buttons to search for  
the next channel. Press the top of the button to search up  
and the bottom of the button to search down. Holding the  
TUNE button causes the radio to bypass channels until  
the button is released.  
Storing and Selecting Pre-Set Channels  
In addition to the 10 AM and 10 FM pre-set stations, you  
may also commit 10 satellite stations to push button  
memory. These satellite channel pre-set stations will not  
erase any AM or FM pre-set memory stations. Follow the  
memory pre-set procedures that apply to your radio.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
164 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
Using the PTY (Program Type) Button (if  
PTY Button ؆SEEK؆  
equipped)  
When the desired program is obtained, press the ЉSEEKЉ  
button within five seconds. The channel will change to  
the next channel that matches the program type selected.  
Follow the PTY button instructions that apply to your  
radio.  
PTY Button ؆SCAN؆  
Satellite Antenna  
When the desired program type is obtained, press the  
ЉSCANЉ button within five seconds. The radio will play 7  
seconds of the selected channel before moving to the next  
channel of the selected program type. Press the ЉSCANЉ  
button a second time to stop the search.  
To ensure optimum reception, do not place items on the  
roof around the rooftop antenna location. Metal objects  
placed within the line of sight of the antenna will cause  
decreased performance. Larger luggage items should be  
placed as far forward as possible. Do not place items  
directly on or above the antenna.  
NOTE: Pressing the ЉSEEKЉ or ЉSCANЉ button while  
performing a music type scan will change the channel by  
one and stop the search. Pressing a pre-set memory  
button during a music type scan, will call up the memory  
channel and stop the search.  
Reception Quality  
Satellite reception may be interrupted due to one of the  
following reasons.  
The vehicle is parked in an underground parking  
structure or under a physical obstacle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 165  
Dense tree coverage may interrupt reception in the  
form of short audio mutes.  
4. Before inserting a tape, make sure that the label is  
adhering flatly to the cassette.  
5. A loose tape should be corrected before use. To rewind  
a loose tape, insert the eraser end of a pencil into the tape  
drive gear and twist the pencil in the required directions.  
Driving under wide bridges or along tall buildings can  
cause intermittent reception.  
Placing objects over or too close to the antenna can  
cause signal blockage.  
Maintain your cassette tape player. The head and capstan  
shaft in the cassette player can pick up dirt or tape  
deposits each time a cassette is played. The result of  
deposits on the capstan shaft may cause the tape to wrap  
around and become lodged in the tape transport. The  
other adverse condition is low or “muddy” sound from  
one or both channels, as if the treble tone control were  
turned all the way down. To prevent this, you should  
periodically clean the head with a commercially available  
WET cleaning cassette.  
4
CASSETTE TAPE AND PLAYER MAINTENANCE  
To keep the cassette tapes and player in good condition,  
take the following precautions:  
1. Do not use cassette tapes longer than C-90; otherwise,  
sound quality and tape durability will be greatly dimin-  
ished.  
2. Keep the cassette tape in its case to protect from  
slackness and dust when it is not in use.  
As preventive maintenance, clean the head about every  
30 hours of use. If you wait until the head becomes very  
3. Keep the cassette tape away from direct sunlight, heat  
and magnetic fields such as the radio speakers.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
166 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
dirty (noticeably poor sound), it may not be possible to  
remove all deposits with a simple WET cleaning cassette.  
7. Do not store the disc where temperatures may become  
too high.  
CD/DVD DISC MAINTENANCE  
To keep the CD/ DVD discs in good condition, take the  
following precautions:  
RADIO OPERATION AND CELLULAR PHONES  
Under certain conditions, the cellular phone being On in  
your vehicle can cause erratic or noisy performance from  
your radio. This condition may be lessened or eliminated  
by relocating the cellular phone antenna. This condition  
is not harmful to the radio. If your radio performance  
does not satisfactorily “clear” by the repositioning of the  
antenna, it is recommended that the radio volume be  
turned down or off during cellular phone operation.  
1. Handle the disc by its edge; avoid touching the  
surface.  
2. If the disc is stained, clean the surface with a soft cloth,  
wiping from center to edge.  
3. Do not apply paper, paper CD labels, or tape to the  
disc; avoid scratching the disc.  
CLIMATE CONTROLS  
4. Do not use solvents such as benzine, thinner, cleaners,  
or antistatic sprays.  
Air Conditioning  
The Air Conditioning System allows you to balance the  
temperature, amount, and direction of air circulating  
throughout the vehicle. The controls are located on the  
instrument panel, above the radio.  
5. Store the disc in its case after playing.  
6. Do not expose the disc to direct sunlight.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 167  
Fan and Air conditioning Control  
Use this control to regulate  
the amount of air forced  
through the system in any  
mode you select. The fan  
speeds to the left of the OFF  
position are for Air Condi-  
tioning. Choosing one of  
these speeds turns on the air  
4
conditioning compressor. The  
fan speed increases as you  
move the control to the left from the OFF position.  
The air conditioning system of your vehicle contains  
R-134a, a refrigerant that does not deplete the ozone layer  
in the upper atmosphere.  
NOTE: The air conditioning compressor will not engage  
until the engine has been running for about 10 seconds.  
Fan speeds to the right of OFF are for heater or ventila-  
tion operation. The fan speed increases as you move the  
control to the right from the OFF position.  
The controls are as follows:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
168 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
Mode Control (Air Direction)  
Bi-Level  
Air is directed through the panel and floor outlets.  
The mode control allows you  
to choose from several pat-  
terns of air distribution. You  
can select either a primary  
mode, as identified by the  
symbols, or a blend of two of  
NOTE: There is a difference in temperature between the  
upper and lower outlets for added comfort. The warmer  
air goes to the floor outlets. This feature gives improved  
comfort during sunny but cool conditions.  
these modes. The center point  
Floor  
between modes gives an even  
Air is directed through the floor outlets and side  
blend of both modes. The  
window demist outlets with  
through the defrost outlet.  
a
small amount  
closer the control is to a par-  
ticular mode, the more air distribution you receive from  
that mode.  
Mix  
Air is directed through the floor, defrost and side  
window demist outlets. This setting works best in  
cold or snowy conditions that require extra heat at  
the windshield. This setting is good for maintaining  
comfort while reducing moisture on the windshield.  
Panel  
Air is directed through the outlets in the instrument  
panel. These outlets can be adjusted to direct air  
flow.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 169  
Defrost  
Air is directed through the windshield and side  
window demist outlets. Use this mode with maxi-  
mum fan and temperature settings for best windshield  
and side window defrosting.  
on the outer edge of each instrument panel outlet grille  
opens or closes a shutter to turn airflow on or off through  
that outlet.  
NOTE: For maximum airflow to the rear seat passen-  
gers, the center instrument panel outlets can be aimed, so  
that the left center outlet is directed toward the right rear  
passenger and the right center outlet is directed toward  
the left rear passenger.  
NOTE: The air conditioning compressor operates in  
both Mix and Defrost or a blend of these modes even if  
the fan switch is not in the A/ C position. This dehumidi-  
fies the air to help dry the windshield. To improve fuel  
economy, use these modes only when necessary.  
4
Temperature Control  
Use this control to regulate  
the temperature of the air in-  
side the passenger compart-  
ment. The blue area of the  
scale indicates cooler tem-  
peratures while the red area  
indicates warmer tempera-  
tures.  
Air Outlets  
The airflow from each of the instrument panel outlets can  
be adjusted for direction and turned on or off to control  
air flow.  
A knob attached in the center of each instrument panel  
outlet is used to adjust the airflow direction, and a knob  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
170 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
NOTE: If your air conditioning performance seems  
lower than expected, check the front of the A/ C con-  
denser: located in front of the radiator, for an accumula-  
tion of dirt or insects. Clean with a gentle water spray  
from behind the radiator and through the condenser.  
Fabric front fascia protectors may reduce air flow to the  
condenser, reducing air conditioning performance.  
This control only operates in the Outside Air and Recir-  
culate modes; there is no in between position. Do not  
place the control between these positions.  
NOTE: Continuous use of the recirculate mode may  
make the inside air stuffy and window fogging may  
occur. Extended use of this mode is not recommended.  
In cold or damp weather, the use of the Recirculate  
position will cause windows to fog on the inside because  
of moisture build up inside the vehicle. For maximum  
defogging, select the Outside Air position.  
Circulation Control  
Use this control to choose be-  
tween outside air intake or  
recirculation of the air inside  
the vehicle. Only use the re-  
circulate mode to temporarily  
block out any outside odors,  
smoke, or dust and to cool the  
interior rapidly upon initial  
start up in very hot or humid  
weather.  
If the mode control is in the range between Mix and  
Defrost and you choose the recirculate mode, the mode  
control knob will automatically move to the left of the  
Mix position.  
NOTE: If you choose Defrost mode and the Circulation  
control is in the recirculate Mode, the system will auto-  
matically switch to the Outside Air mode and the knob  
will move to that position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 171  
Operating Tips  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
172 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
Window Fogging  
Summer Operation  
Vehicle side windows tend to fog on the inside in mild  
rainy or humid weather. To clear the windows, use the  
A/ C, PANEL and blower controls. Direct the panel  
outlets toward the side windows. Do not use recirculate  
without A/ C for long periods as fogging may occur.  
Air conditioned vehicles must be protected with a high-  
quality antifreeze coolant to provide proper corrosion  
protection and to raise the boiling point of the coolant for  
protection against overheating. A 50% concentration is  
recommended.  
Interior fogging on the windshield can be quickly re-  
moved by using the defrost position.  
Outside Air Intake  
When operating the system during the winter months,  
make sure the air intake, directly in front of the wind-  
shield, is free of ice, slush, snow or other obstructions  
such as leaves. Leaves collected in the air-intake plenum  
may reduce air flow and plug the plenum water drains.  
If the fogging problem persists, clean the inside window  
surfaces. The cause of undue fogging may be dirt collect-  
ing on the inside surface of the glass  
NOTE: In cold weather, the use of the recirculate  
position will cause windows to fog on the inside because  
of moisture build up inside the vehicle. For maximum  
defogging, use the Outside Air position.  
The blower air will heat faster in cold weather if you use  
only a low blower speed for the first few minutes of  
vehicle operation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 173  
Side Window Demisters  
A side window demister outlet is at each end of the  
instrument panel. These nonadjustable outlets direct air  
toward the side windows when the system is in either the  
FLOOR, MIX, or DEFROST mode. The air is directed at  
the area of the windows through which you view the  
outside mirrors.  
4
REAR WINDOW FEATURES  
Electric Rear Window Defroster  
The push-button is located at the center of the  
instrument panel, below the radio. Press this but-  
ton to turn on the rear window defroster, and the  
optional electric remote control heated mirrors. An amber  
light shows that the defroster is on.  
NOTE: The defroster turns off automatically after 10  
minutes of operation. Each following activation of the  
defroster will last for five minutes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
174 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL  
CAUTION!  
To avoid damaging the electrical conductors, do not  
use scrapers, sharp instruments, or abrasive window  
cleaners on the interior surface of the rear window.  
Labels can be peeled off after soaking with warm  
water.  
Rear Wiper/Washer Switch  
A push-button at the center of the instrument panel,  
below the radio, turns the rear wiper ON or OFF. When  
this switch is pressed the rear wiper will operate at a  
fixed interval of about 4 seconds between wipes.  
Press and hold the switch as long as spray is  
desired. If the switch is depressed while the wiper  
is on, the wiper will operate for a few seconds after  
the switch is released then resume the previously set  
mode of intermittent wiper.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 175  
Adding Washer Fluid  
The fluid reservoir for the windshield washers and the  
rear window washer is shared. It is located in the rear of  
the engine compartment on the passenger side and  
should be checked for fluid level at regular intervals. Fill  
the reservoir with windshield washer solvent (not radia-  
tor antifreeze) and operate the system for a few seconds  
to flush out the residual water.  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING  
CONTENTS  
Starting Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180  
Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180  
Manual Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180  
Normal Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180  
Automatic Transaxle — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . 183  
Brake/ Transmission Interlock System . . . . . . . 184  
5
Automatic Transaxle Ignition Interlock  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184  
Four Speed Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . 184  
Reset Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184  
Extremely Cold Weather  
(Below Ϫ20°F Or Ϫ29°C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181  
If Engine Fails To Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181  
After Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182  
Turbocharger “Cool Down” . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182  
Gear Ranges For Four Speed Automatic  
Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185  
AutoStick — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187  
AutoStick Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
178 STARTING AND OPERATING  
AutoStick General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . 188  
Manual Transaxle Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189  
2.4 Liter Turbo— If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190  
Recommended Shift Speeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190  
Downshifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191  
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192  
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194  
Tire Identification Number (TIN) . . . . . . . . . . 201  
Tire Loading And Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . 202  
Tires—General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206  
Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206  
Tire Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207  
Radial-Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210  
Compact Spare Tire — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . 210  
Tire Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211  
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212  
Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212  
Alignment And Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213  
Tire Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) — If  
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194  
Power Assisted Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196  
Traction Control — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . 196  
Tire Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197  
Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 179  
Tire Rotation Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . 215  
Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
Materials Added To Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219  
Fuel System Cautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219  
Carbon Monoxide Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220  
Adding Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221  
Fuel Filler Cap (Gas Cap) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221  
Vehicle Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223  
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223  
Warranty Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224  
2.4L Standard Engine And 2.4L Standard  
Turbo Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
2.4L High Output Turbo Engine . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217  
Gasoline/ Oxygenate Blends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217  
MMT In Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218  
Sulfur In Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
180 STARTING AND OPERATING  
STARTING PROCEDURES  
Automatic Transaxle  
Before starting your vehicle, adjust your seat, adjust both  
inside and outside mirrors, and fasten your seat belts.  
The gear selector must be in the NEUTRAL or PARK  
position before you can start the engine. Apply the brakes  
before shifting to any driving gear.  
NOTE: You must press the brake pedal before shifting  
out of Park.  
CAUTION!  
Long periods of engine idling, especially at high  
engine speeds can cause excessive exhaust tempera-  
tures which can damage your vehicle. Do not leave  
your vehicle unattended with the engine running.  
Manual Transaxle  
Before starting the engine fully apply the parking brake,  
press the clutch pedal to the floor and place the gear  
selector in NEUTRAL.  
NOTE: The engine will not start unless the clutch pedal  
is pressed to the floor.  
WARNING!  
Normal Starting  
Do not leave children or animals inside parked  
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build up may  
cause serious injury or death.  
Normal Starting of either a cold or a warm engine does  
not require pumping or depressing the accelerator pedal.  
Simply turn the ignition switch to the “START’” position  
and release when the engine starts. If the engine has not  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 181  
started within 3 seconds, slightly depress the accelerator  
pedal while continuing to crank. If the engine fails to start  
within 15 seconds, turn the ignition switch to the “OFF”  
position, wait 10 to 15 seconds, then repeat the normal  
starting procedure.  
Extremely Cold Weather (below Ϫ20°F or Ϫ29°C)  
To insure reliable starting at these temperatures, use of an  
externally powered electric engine block heater (available  
from your dealer) is recommended.  
If Engine Fails to Start  
If the engine fails to start after you have followed the  
“NORMAL STARTING” procedure, it may be flooded.  
Push the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and  
hold it there. Crank the engine for no more than 15  
seconds. This should clear any excess fuel in case the  
engine is flooded. Leave the ignition key in the ON  
position, release the accelerator pedal and repeat the  
“NORMAL STARTING” procedure.  
WARNING!  
Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to get it  
started. Vehicles equipped with an automatic trans-  
axle cannot be started this way. Unburned fuel could  
enter the catalytic converter and once the engine has  
started, ignite and damage the converter and vehicle.  
If the vehicle has a discharged battery, booster cables  
may be used to obtain a start from another vehicle.  
This type of start can be dangerous if done improp-  
erly, so follow the procedure carefully. See section 6  
of this manual for jump starting instructions.  
5
WARNING!  
Never pour fuel or other flammable liquid into the  
throttle body air inlet opening in an attempt to start  
the vehicle. This could result in flash fire causing  
serious personal injury.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
182 STARTING AND OPERATING  
Turbocharger “Cool Down”  
CAUTION!  
NOTE: Letting the engine idle after severe operation  
allows the turbine housing to cool to normal operating  
temperature.  
To prevent damage to the starter, do not crank the  
engine for more than 15 seconds at a time. Wait 10 to  
15 seconds before trying again.  
The following chart should be used as a guide in deter-  
minning the amount of engine idle time required to  
sufficiently cool down the turbocharger before shut  
down, depending upon the type of driving and the  
amount of cargo.  
After Starting  
The idle speed will automatically decrease as the engine  
warms up.  
TURBOCHARGER ؆COOL DOWN؆ CHART  
Driving Conditions  
Normal Driving  
Idle Time (in minutes) Before Shut Down  
Not required.  
Aggressive Driving or Heavily Loaded  
Trailer Tow  
3
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 183  
AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE — IF EQUIPPED  
NOTE: You MUST press and hold the brake pedal down  
while shifting out of Park.  
CAUTION!  
WARNING!  
Damage to the transaxle may occur if the following  
precautions are not observed:  
It is dangerous to shift the selector lever out of “P” or  
“N” if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If  
your foot is not firmly on the brake pedal, the  
vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in re-  
verse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit  
someone or something. Only shift into gear when  
the engine is idling normally and when your right  
foot is firmly on the brake pedal.  
Shift into PARK only after the vehicle has come to a  
complete stop.  
5
Shift into or out of REVERSE only after the vehicle has  
come to a complete stop and the engine is at idle  
speed.  
Do not shift from REVERSE, PARK, or NEUTRAL into  
any forward gear when the engine is above idle speed.  
Before shifting into any gear, make sure your foot is  
firmly on the brake pedal.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
184 STARTING AND OPERATING  
Brake/Transmission Interlock System  
Four Speed Automatic Transaxle  
This system prevents you from moving the gear shift out  
of Park and into any gear unless the brake pedal is  
pressed. This system is active only while the ignition  
switch is in the ON positions. Always depress the brake  
pedal first, before moving the gear selector out of PARK.  
The electronically controlled transaxle provides a precise  
shift schedule. The transaxle electronics are self calibrat-  
ing; therefore, the first few shifts on a new vehicle may be  
somewhat abrupt. This is a normal condition, and preci-  
sion shifts will develop within a few shift cycles.  
Automatic Transaxle Ignition Interlock System  
This system prevents the key from being removed unless  
the shift lever is in PARK and the shift knob push button  
is out. It also prevents shifting out of PARK unless the  
key is in the OFF or ON positions.  
Reset Mode  
The transaxle is monitored electronically for abnormal  
conditions. If a condition is detected that could cause  
damage, the transaxle shifts automatically into second  
gear. The transaxle remains in second gear despite the  
forward gear selected. Park (P), Reverse (R), and Neutral  
(N) will continue to operate. This second gear limp-in  
feature allows the vehicle to be driven to a dealer for  
service without damaging the transaxle.  
NOTE: If a malfunction occurs, the system will trap the  
key in the ignition cylinder to warn you that this safety  
feature is inoperable. The engine can be started and  
stopped but the key cannot be removed until you obtain  
service.  
In the event that the problem has been momentary, the  
transaxle can be reset to regain all forward gears.  
Stop the vehicle and shift into Park (P).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 185  
Turn the Key to OFF then restart the engine.  
Shift into D and resume driving.  
brake when leaving the vehicle in this range. Always  
apply the parking brake first, and then place the selector  
in P (Park) position.  
NOTE: Even if the transaxle can be reset, it is recom-  
mended that you visit a dealer at your earliest possible  
convenience. Your dealer has diagnostic equipment to  
determine if the problem could recur.  
WARNING!  
Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure  
those in and near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,  
you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is  
running. Before exiting a vehicle, you should always  
shift the vehicle into P (Park), remove the key from  
the ignition, and apply the parking brake. Once the  
key is removed from the ignition, the transmission  
shift lever is locked in the P (Park) position, securing  
the vehicle against unwanted movement. Further-  
more, you should never leave children unattended  
inside a vehicle.  
If the transaxle cannot be reset, dealer service is required.  
5
Gear Ranges For Four Speed Automatic  
Transaxle  
DO NOT race the engine when shifting from PARK or  
NEUTRAL positions into another gear range.  
“P” Park  
Supplements the parking brake by locking the transmis-  
sion. The engine can be started in this range. Never use P  
(Park) while the vehicle is in motion. Apply the parking  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
186 STARTING AND OPERATING  
The following indicators should be used to ensure that  
you have engaged the transmission shift lever into the P  
(Park) position:  
“R” Reverse  
Shift into this range only after the vehicle has come to a  
complete stop.  
When shifting into P (Park), depress the button on the  
shift lever and firmly move the lever all the way  
forward until it stops.  
“N” Neutral  
Engine may be started in this range.  
“D” Overdrive  
Look at the shift indicator window on the console to  
ensure it is in the P (Park) position.  
This range should be used for most city and highway  
driving. It provides smoothest up shifts and down shifts  
and best fuel economy.  
When engaged in P (Park), you will not be able to  
move the shifter rearward without depressing the shift  
lever button.  
When frequent transaxle shifting occurs while using the  
Overdrive range, such as when operating the vehicle  
under heavy loading conditions (in hilly terrain, travel-  
ing into strong head winds, or while towing trailers), use  
the “3” range.  
CAUTION!  
Before moving the shift lever out of P (Park), you must  
turn the ignition from LOCK to ON so the steering  
wheel and shift lever are released. Otherwise, damage  
to the steering column or shifter could result.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 187  
“3” Drive  
AUTOSTICK — IF EQUIPPED  
This range eliminates shifts into Overdrive. The transaxle  
will operate normally in first and second while in this  
range.  
Autostick is a driver-interactive transmission that offers  
manual gear shifting capability to provide you with more  
control. Autostick allows you to maximize engine brak-  
ing, eliminate undesirable upshifts and downshifts, and  
improve overall vehicle performance. This system can  
also provide you with more control during passing, city  
driving, cold slippery conditions, mountain driving,  
trailer towing, and many other situations.  
NOTE: Using the “3” range while operating the vehicle  
under heavy operating conditions will improve perfor-  
mance, fuel economy, and extend transaxle life by reduc-  
ing excessive shifting and heat build up.  
5
Use the “3” range when descending steep grades to  
prevent brake system distress.  
Autostick Operation  
The Autostick position is just below the Overdrive posi-  
tion and is identified by the word “AUTOSTICK”. When  
you place the shift lever in the Autostick position, it can  
be moved from side to side. Moving the lever to the left  
(-) triggers a downshift and to the right (+) an upshift.  
The gear position will be shown in the transmission gear  
display, located in the instrument cluster.  
“1” Low  
This range should be used for maximum engine braking  
when descending steep grades. In this range, up shifts  
will occur only to prevent engine over speed while down  
shifts from 2nd to first will occur as early as possible.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
188 STARTING AND OPERATING  
You can shift in or out of the autostick mode at any time  
without taking your foot off the accelerator pedal. If you  
choose the Overdrive mode, the transmission will oper-  
ate automatically; shifting between the four available  
gears. When you wish to engage autostick, simply move  
the shift lever to the AUTOSTICK position. The transmis-  
sion will remain in the current gear until an upshift or  
downshift is chosen.  
You can start out in first, second, or third gear. Shifting  
into fourth gear can occur only after vehicle speed  
reaches 15 mph (24 km/ h).  
The transmission will automatically downshift to first  
gear when coming to a stop.  
Starting out in third gear is helpful in snowy or icy  
conditions.  
While in the Autostick mode, Speed Control will only  
function in third or fourth gear.  
Move the lever back to the Overdrive position to shift out  
of the Autostick mode.  
Downshifting out of third gear will turn off the speed  
control.  
Autostick General Information  
The transmission will automatically upshift from first  
to second gear and from second to third gear when  
engine speed reaches about 6300 RPM.  
If the system detects powertrain overheating, the  
transmission will revert to the automatic shift mode  
and remain in that mode until the powertrain cools off.  
Downshifts from third to second gear above 74 mph  
(119 km/ h) and from second to first gear above 41  
mph (66 km/ h) will be ignored.  
If the system detects a problem it will disable the  
Autostick mode and the transmission will return to the  
automatic mode until the problem is corrected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 189  
MANUAL TRANSAXLE OPERATION  
Use each gear in numerical order - do not skip a gear. Be  
sure the transaxle is in FIRST gear, (not THIRD), when  
starting from a standing position. Damage to the clutch  
can result from starting in THIRD.  
NOTE: The parking brake should be engaged and the  
gear selector placed in REVERSE before leaving the  
vehicle, especially on an incline.  
For most city driving you will find it easier to use only  
the lower gears. For steady highway driving with light  
accelerations, 5th gear is recommended.  
Fully depress the clutch pedal before you shift gears. As  
you release the clutch pedal, lightly depress the accelera-  
tor pedal.  
Never drive with your foot resting on the clutch pedal, or  
try to hold the vehicle on a hill with the clutch pedal  
partially engaged. This will cause abnormal wear on the  
clutch.  
5
Never shift into REVERSE until the vehicle has come to a  
complete stop.  
NOTE: During cold weather, until the transaxle lubri-  
cant is warm, you may experience slightly higher shift  
efforts. This is normal and not harmful to the transaxle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
190 STARTING AND OPERATING  
2.4 Liter Turbo— If Equipped  
When moving the shifter lever into REVERSE press the  
lever to the left until the resistance is overcome. When the  
ignition switch is in the ON position, a chime will sound  
to confirm that reverse has been selected and the backup  
lights will illuminate.  
NOTE: Listen for the audible chime to confirm RE-  
VERSE gear is properly selected. Never shift into RE-  
VERSE until the vehicle has come to a complete stop.  
Recommended Shift Speeds  
To use your manual transaxle for optimal fuel economy,  
it should be upshifted as listed in table 1.  
The neutral position of the shift lever is located between  
THIRD and FOURTH gear. This is the position the shifter  
lever will return to automatically when neutral is se-  
lected. When shifting into FIFTH gear, be sure to press  
the shifter lever all the way to the right to avoid acciden-  
tally selecting THIRD gear. Also, use care when selecting  
FIRST gear to avoid accidentally selecting REVERSE.  
TABLE 1-MANUAL TRANSAXLE NORMAL  
ACCELERATION AND CRUISE SHIFT SPEEDS  
IN mph (km/h)  
ENGINE  
SIZE  
1 to 2  
2 to 3  
3 to 4  
4 to 5  
15  
25  
33  
44  
2.4L  
(24)  
(40)  
(53)  
(70)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 191  
For improved performance, your manual transaxle may  
be upshifted up to the maximum speeds listed in table 2  
(within legal speed limits).  
Downshifting  
Proper downshifting will improve fuel economy and  
prolong engine life.  
TABLE 2-MANUAL TRANSAXLE MAXIMUM  
PERFORMANCE SHIFT SPEEDS  
CAUTION!  
IN mph (km/h)  
If you skip more than one gear while downshifting  
or downshift at too high an engine speed, you could  
damage the engine, transmission, or clutch.  
ENGINE  
SIZE  
1 to 2  
2 to 3  
3 to 4  
4 to 5  
30  
60  
85  
115  
5
2.4L  
(48)  
(97)  
(136)  
(185)  
To maintain a safe speed and prolong brake life, shift  
down to 2nd or 1st when descending a steep grade.  
If you exceed these speeds, you may notice the engine cut  
in and out. This is caused by an electronic limiter in the  
engine computer. The engine will run normally when  
you reduce engine speed.  
When turning a corner, or driving up a steep grade,  
downshift early so that the engine will not be overbur-  
dened.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
192 STARTING AND OPERATING  
PARKING BRAKE  
slightly on the lever, then depress the button on the end  
of the lever and push the lever fully down toward the  
floor.  
When the parking brake is applied with the  
ignition on, the Brake Light in the instrument  
cluster will come on.  
NOTE: The parking brake lever will not release unless  
the lever is pulled up slightly past its applied position.  
NOTE: This light only shows that the parking brake is  
on. It does not show the degree of brake application.  
If the parking brake is applied while the vehicle is  
moving, a chime will sound to alert the driver. The chime  
will sound up to 10 times or until the vehicle has  
returned to a stop.  
Before leaving the vehicle, make sure that the parking  
brake is set. To set the parking brake, pull up firmly on  
the lever. Also place the gear selector in the Park position  
(automatic transaxle) or Reverse (manual transaxle). To  
release the parking brake, apply the brake pedal, pull up  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 193  
When parking on a hill, it is important to set the parking  
brake before placing the gear selector in Park, otherwise  
the load on the automatic transaxle locking mechanism  
may make it difficult to move the selector out of Park. As  
an added precaution, turn the front wheels toward the  
curb on a downhill grade and away from the curb on a  
uphill grade.  
WARNING!  
Leaving children in a vehicle unattended is dan-  
gerous for a number of reasons. A child or others  
could be injured. Children should be warned not  
to touch the parking brake or the gear selector.  
Dont leave the keys in the ignition. A child could  
operate power windows, other controls, or move  
the vehicle.  
You should always apply the parking brake before leav-  
ing the vehicle.  
5
Be sure the parking brake is fully disengaged  
before driving; failure to do so can lead to brake  
failure and an accident.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
194 STARTING AND OPERATING  
BRAKE SYSTEM  
If either of the two hydraulic systems lose normal capa-  
bility, the remaining system will still function with some  
loss of overall braking effectiveness. This will be evident  
by increased pedal travel during application and greater  
pedal force required to slow or stop. In addition, if the  
malfunction is caused by an internal leak, as the brake  
fluid in the master cylinder drops, the brake warning  
indicator will light.  
Your vehicle is equipped with power assisted brakes as  
standard equipment. In the event power assist is lost for  
any reason (for example, repeated brake applications  
with the engine off), the brakes will still function. How-  
ever, the effort required to brake the vehicle will be much  
greater than that required with the power system oper-  
ating.  
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) — If Equipped  
The ABS gives increased vehicle stability and brake  
performance under most braking conditions. The system  
automatically “pumps” the brakes during severe braking  
conditions to prevent wheel lock up.  
WARNING!  
Riding the brakes can lead to brake failure and  
possibly an accident. Driving with your foot resting  
or riding on the brake pedal can result in abnormally  
high brake temperatures, excessive lining wear, and  
possible brake damage. You wouldnt have your full  
braking capacity in an emergency.  
All vehicle wheels and tires must be the same size and  
tires must be properly inflated to produce accurate  
signals for the computer. However, the system will  
compensate when the compact spare is in use.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 195  
During stops where ABS is activated, a vibration of the  
brake pedal may be felt and associated system noises  
may be heard.  
WARNING!  
Anti-lock system (ABS) cannot prevent the natu-  
ral laws of physics from acting on the vehicle, nor  
can it increase braking or steering efficiency be-  
yond that afforded by the condition of the vehicle  
brakes and tires or the traction afforded.  
NOTE: Pumping of the brake pedal will diminish the  
effectiveness of Anti-lock brakes and may lead to an  
accident. Pumping makes the stopping distance longer.  
Just press firmly on your brake pedal when you need to  
slow down or stop.  
The ABS cannot prevent accidents, including  
those resulting from excessive speed in turns,  
following another vehicle too closely, or hydro-  
planing. Only a safe, attentive, and skillful driver  
can prevent accidents.  
5
The capabilities of an ABS equipped vehicle must  
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous  
manner which could jeopardize the users safety  
or the safety of others.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
196 STARTING AND OPERATING  
POWER ASSISTED STEERING  
The power assisted steering system of your vehicle  
provides mechanical steering capability in the event  
power assist is lost.  
If for some reason the hydraulic pressure is interrupted,  
it will still be possible to steer your vehicle. Under these  
conditions you will observe a substantial increase in  
steering effort.  
TRACTION CONTROL — IF EQUIPPED  
The Traction Control System will improve acceleration  
and steering on slippery surfaces by reducing tire spin.  
The system reduces wheel slip and maintains traction at  
the driving (front) wheels by engaing the brake on the  
wheel that is losing traction. When this occurs the TRAC  
indicator light located above the instrument cluster  
odometer will flash. The system operates at speeds below  
40 mph (64 km/ h).  
A push-button at the center of the instrument panel,  
below the radio, turns the Traction Control System ON or  
OFF.  
The system is always in the “ON” mode unless:  
The TRAC OFF switch has been used to turn the  
system off;  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 197  
There is a Anti-Lock Brake System malfunction;  
There is a Traction Control System malfunction;  
TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION  
Tire Markings  
The system has been automatically deactivated to  
prevent damage to the brake system due to overheated  
brake temperatures.  
NOTE: Extended heavy use of Traction Control may  
cause the system to deactivate and turn on the TRAC  
OFF Light located in the instrument cluster.  
5
This is to prevent overheating of the brake system and is  
a normal condition. The system will remain disabled for  
about 4 minutes until the brakes have cooled. The sytem  
will automatically reactivate and turn off the TRAC OFF  
light.  
NOTE:  
If your vehicle becomes stuck in mud, ice, or snow, turn  
the Traction Control System Off before attempting to  
“rock” the vehicle free.  
P(Passenger)-Metric tire sizing is based on U.S. design  
standards. P-Metric tires have the letter “P” molded  
into the sidewall preceding the size designation. Ex-  
ample: P215/ 65R15 95H.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
198 STARTING AND OPERATING  
European Metric tire sizing is based on European  
design standards. Tires designed to this standard have  
the tire size molded into the sidewall beginning with  
the section width. The letter ЉPЉ is absent from this tire  
size designation. Example: 215/ 65R15 96H  
Temporary Spare tires are high pressure compact  
spares designed for temporary emergency use only.  
Tires designed to this standard have the letter “T”  
molded into the sidewall preceding the size designa-  
tion. Example: T145/ 80D18 103M.  
LT(Light Truck)-Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.  
design standards. The size designation for LT-Metric  
tires is the same as for P-Metric tires except for the  
letters “LT” that are molded into the sidewall preced-  
ing the size designation. Example: LT235/ 85R16.  
High Flotation tire sizing is based on U.S. design  
standards and begins with the tire diameter molded  
into the sidewall. Example: 31x10.5 R15 LT.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 199  
Tire Sizing Chart  
Size Designation:  
EXAMPLE:  
P = Passenger car tire size based on U.S. design standards  
؆....blank....؆ = Passenger car tire based on European design standards  
LT = Light Truck tire based on U.S. design standards  
T = Temporary Spare tire  
31 = Overall Diameter in Inches (in)  
5
215 = Section Width in Milimeters (mm)  
65 = Aspect Ratio in Percent (%)  
—Ratio of section height to section width of tire.  
10.5 = Section Width in Inches (in)  
R = Construction Code  
ЉRЉ means Radial Construction.  
ЉDЉ means Diagonal or Bias Construction.  
15 = Rim Diameter in Inches (in)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
200 STARTING AND OPERATING  
EXAMPLE:  
Service Description:  
95 = Load Index  
—A numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can carry.  
H = Speed Symbol  
—A symbol indicating the range of speeds at which a tire can carry a load corresponding  
to its load index under certain operating conditions.  
—The maximum speed corresponding to the Speed Symbol should only be achieved un-  
der specified operating conditions. (ie. tire pressure, vehicle loading, road conditions and  
posted speed limits).  
Load Identification:  
؆....blank....؆ = Absence of any text on sidewall of the tire indicates a Standard Load (SL) Tire  
Extra Load (XL) = Extra Load (or Reinforced) Tire  
Light Load = Light Load Tire  
C,D,E = Load range associated with the maximum load a tire can carry at a specified pressure  
Maximum Load — Maximum Load indicates the maximum load this tire is designed to carry.  
Maximum Pressure — Maximum Pressure indicates the maximum permissible cold tire inflation pressure for this  
tire.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 201  
Tire Identification Number (TIN)  
Look for the TIN on the outboard side of black sidewall  
tires as mounted on the vehicle. If the TIN is not found on  
the outboard side then you will find it on the inboard side  
of the tire.  
The TIN may be found on one or both sides of the tire  
however the date code may only be on one side. Tires  
with white sidewalls will have the full TIN including  
date code located on the white sidewall side of the tire.  
EXAMPLE:  
DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301  
DOT = Department of Transportation  
—This symbol certifies that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation tire  
safety standards, and is approved for highway use.  
5
MA = Code representing the tire manufacturing location.(2 digits)  
L9 = Code representing the tire size.(2 digits)  
ABCD = Code used by tire manufacturer.(1 to 4 digits)  
03 = Number representing the week in which the tire was manufactured.(2 digits)  
—03 means the 3rd week.  
01 = Number representing the year in which the tire was manufactured.(2 digits)  
—01 means the year 2001.  
—Prior to July 2000, tire manufacturers were only required to have 1 number to represent the year in  
which the tire was manufactured. Example: 031 could represent the 3rd week of 1981 or 1991.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
202 STARTING AND OPERATING  
Tire Loading and Tire Pressure  
Tire Placard Location  
Tire and Loading Information Placard  
NOTE: Some vehicles have a “Tire and Loading Infor-  
mation” placard located on the drivers side “Bpillar.  
This placard tells you important information about the,  
1) number of people that can be carried in the vehicle  
2) the total weight your vehicle can carry  
3) the tire size designed for your vehicle  
4) the cold tire inflation pressures for the front, rear  
and spare tires.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 203  
Loading  
To determine the maximum loading conditions of your  
vehicle, locate the statement “The combined weight of  
occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX  
lbs.” on the Tire and Loading Information placard. The  
combined weight of occupants, cargo/ luggage and  
trailer tongue weight (if applicable) should never exceed  
the weight referenced here.  
The vehicle maximum load on the tire must not exceed  
the load carrying capacity of the tire on your vehicle. You  
will not exceed the tires load carrying capacity if you  
adhere to the loading conditions, tire size and cold tire  
inflation pressures specified on the Tire and Loading  
Information placard and the Vehicle Loading section of  
this manual.  
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit  
NOTE: Under a maximum loaded vehicle condition,  
gross axle weight ratings (GAWRs) for the front and rear  
axles must not be exceeded. For further information on  
GAWR’s, vehicle loading and trailer towing, see the  
Vehicle Loading section of this manual.  
5
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occu-  
pants and cargo should never exceed XXX pounds” on  
your vehicles placard.  
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and  
passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
204 STARTING AND OPERATING  
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and pas-  
sengers from XXX kilograms or XXX pounds.  
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your  
trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this  
manual to determine how this reduces the available  
cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.  
4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of  
cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if “XXX”  
amount equals 1400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb.  
passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo  
and luggage load capacity is 650 lb. (1400–750 (5 x 150) =  
650 lb.)  
NOTE: The following table shows examples on how to  
calculate total load, cargo/ luggage and towing capacities  
of your vehicle with varying seating configurations and  
number and size of occupants. This table is for illustra-  
tion purposes only and may not be accurate for the  
seating and load carry capacity of your vehicle.  
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo  
being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely  
exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity  
calculated in step 4.  
NOTE: For the following example the combined weight  
of occupants and cargo should never exceed 865 lbs. (392  
Kg).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 205  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
206 STARTING AND OPERATING  
1. Safety—  
WARNING!  
WARNING!  
Overloading of your tire is dangerous. Overloading  
can cause tire failure, affect vehicle handling, and  
increase your stopping distance. Use tires of the  
recommended load capacity for your vehicle. Never  
overload them.  
Improperly inflated tires are dangerous and can  
cause accidents.  
Under inflation increases tire flexing and can  
result in tire failure.  
Over inflation reduces a tires ability to cushion  
shock. Objects on the road and chuck holes can cause  
damage that results in tire failure.  
TIRES—GENERAL INFORMATION  
Unequal tire pressures can cause steering prob-  
lems. You could lose control of your vehicle.  
Over inflated or under inflated tires can affect  
Tire Pressure  
Proper tire inflation pressure is essential to the safe and  
satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Three primary  
areas are affected by improper tire pressure:  
vehicle handling and can fail suddenly, resulting in  
loss of vehicle control.  
Unequal tire pressures from one side of the vehicle  
to the other can cause the vehicle to drift to the right  
or left.  
Always drive with each tire inflated to the recom-  
mended cold tire inflation pressure.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 207  
2. Economy—  
Some vehicles may have Supplemental Tire Pressure  
Information for vehicle loads that are less that the maxi-  
mum loaded vehicle condition. These pressure condi-  
tions will be found in the “Supplemental Tire Pressure  
Information” section of this manual.  
Improper inflation pressures can cause uneven wear  
patterns to develop across the tire tread. These abnormal  
wear patterns will reduce tread life resulting in a need for  
earlier tire replacement. Underinflation also increases tire  
rolling resistance and results in higher fuel consumption.  
3. Ride Comfort and Vehicle Stability—  
Proper tire inflation contributes to a comfortable ride.  
Overinflation produces a jarring and uncomfortable ride.  
5
Tire Inflation Pressures  
The proper cold tire inflation pressure for passenger cars  
is listed on either the face of the drivers door or the  
drivers side “Bpillar. For vehicles other than passenger  
cars, the cold tire inflation pressures are listed on either  
the “Bpillar, the Certification Label or in the Tire  
Inflation Pressures brochure in the glove compartment.  
“B” PILLAR  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
208 STARTING AND OPERATING  
The pressure should be checked and adjusted as well as  
inspecting for signs of tire wear or visible damage at least  
once a month. Use a good quality pocket-type gauge to  
check tire pressure. Do not make a visual judgement  
when determining proper inflation. Radial tires may look  
properly inflated even when they are underinflated.  
(1 km) after a 3 hour period. The cold tire inflation  
pressure must not exceed the maximum inflation pres-  
sure molded into the tire side wall.  
Check tire pressures more often if subject to a wide range  
of outdoor temperatures, as tire pressures vary with  
temperature changes.  
Tire pressures change by approximately 1 psi (7 kPa) per  
12° F (7° C) of air temperature change. Keep this in mind  
when checking tire pressure inside a garage especially in  
the winter.  
CAUTION!  
After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure al-  
ways reinstall the valve stem cap–if equipped. This  
will prevent moisture and dirt from entering the  
valve stem, which could damage the valve stem.  
Example: If garage temperature = 68° F (20° C) and the  
outside temperature = 32° F (0° C) then the cold tire  
inflation pressure should be increased by 3 psi (21 kPa),  
which equals 1 psi (7 kPa) for every 12° F (7° C) for this  
outside temperature condition.  
Inflation pressures specified on the placard are always  
“cold tire inflation pressure”. Cold tire inflation pressure  
is defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has not  
been driven for at least 3 hours, or driven less than 1mile  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 209  
Tire pressure may increase from 2 to 6 psi (13 to 40 kPa)  
during operation. DO NOT reduce this normal pressure  
build up or your tire pressure will be too low.  
WARNING!  
High speed driving with your vehicle under maxi-  
mum load is dangerous. The added strain on your  
tires could cause them to fail. You could have a  
serious accident. Dont drive a vehicle loaded to the  
maximum capacity at continuous speeds above 75  
mph (120 km/h).  
Tire Pressures for High Speed Operation  
The manufacturer advocates driving at safe speeds  
within posted speed limits. Where speed limits or condi-  
tions are such that the vehicle can be driven at high  
speeds, maintaining correct tire inflation pressure is very  
important. Increased tire pressure and reduced vehicle  
loading may be required for high speed vehicle opera-  
tion. Refer to original equipment or an authorized tire  
dealer for recommended safe operating speeds, loading  
and cold tire inflation pressures.  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
210 STARTING AND OPERATING  
Radial-Ply Tires  
Compact Spare Tire — If Equipped  
The compact spare is for temporary emergency use with  
radial tires. It is engineered to be used on your style  
vehicle only. Since this tire has limited tread life, the  
original tire should be repaired (or replaced) and rein-  
stalled at the first opportunity.  
WARNING!  
Combining radial ply tires with other types of tires  
on your vehicle will cause your vehicle to handle  
poorly. The instability could cause an accident. Al-  
ways use radial ply tires in sets of four (or 6, in case  
of trucks with dual rear wheels). Never combine  
them with other types of tires.  
WARNING!  
Temporary use spare tires are for emergency use  
only. With these tires, do not drive more than 50 mph  
(80 km/h). Temporary-use spare tires have limited  
tread life. When two or more tread wear indicators  
appear in adjacent grooves, the temporary use spare  
tire needs to be replaced. Be sure to follow the  
warnings which apply to your spare. Failure to do so  
could result in spare tire failure and loss of vehicle  
control.  
Cuts and punctures in radial tires are repairable only in  
the tread area because of sidewall flexing. Consult your  
authorized tire dealer for radial tire repairs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 211  
Do not install a wheel cover or attempt to mount a  
conventional tire on the compact spare wheel, since the  
wheel is designed specifically for the compact spare.  
Tire Spinning  
When stuck in mud, sand, snow, or ice conditions, do not  
spin your vehicles wheels above 35 mph (55 km/ h).  
Do not install more than one compact spare tire/ wheel  
on the vehicle at any given time.  
See the paragraph on Freeing A Stuck Vehicle in Section  
6 of this manual.  
WARNING!  
CAUTION!  
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces gener-  
ated by excessive wheel speeds may cause tire dam-  
age or failure. A tire could explode and injure  
someone. Do not spin your vehicles wheels faster  
than 35 mph (55 km/h) when you are stuck. And  
dont let anyone near a spinning wheel, no matter  
what the speed.  
5
Because of the reduced ground clearance, do not take  
your vehicle through an automatic car wash with the  
compact spare installed. Damage to the vehicle may  
result.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
212 STARTING AND OPERATING  
Tread Wear Indicators  
Many states have laws requiring tire replacement at this  
point.  
Tread wear indicators are in the original equipment tires  
to help you in determining when your tires should be  
replaced.  
Replacement Tires  
The tires on your new vehicle provide a balance of many  
characteristics. They should be inspected regularly for  
wear and correct cold tire inflation pressure. The manu-  
facturer strongly recommends that you use tires equiva-  
lent to the originals in size, quality and performance  
when replacement is needed (see the paragraph on tread  
wear indicators). Refer to the Tire and Loading Informa-  
tion placard for the size designation of your tire. The  
service description and load identification will be found  
on the original equipment tire. Failure to use equivalent  
replacement tires may adversely affect the safety, han-  
dling, and ride of your vehicle. We recommend that you  
contact your original equipment or an authorized tire  
dealer with any questions you may have on tire specifi-  
cations or capability.  
These indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread  
grooves and will appear as bands when the tread depth  
becomes 1/ 16 inch (2 mm). When the indicators appear  
in 2 or more adjacent grooves, the tire should be replaced.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 213  
WARNING!  
CAUTION!  
Do not use a tire, wheel size or rating other than  
that specified for your vehicle. Some combina-  
tions of unapproved tires and wheels may change  
suspension dimensions and performance charac-  
teristics, resulting in changes to steering, han-  
dling, and braking of your vehicle. This can cause  
unpredictable handling and stress to steering and  
suspension components. You could lose control  
and have an accident resulting in serious injury or  
death. Use only the tire and wheel sizes with load  
ratings approved for your vehicle.  
Replacing original tires with tires of a different size  
may result in false speedometer and odometer read-  
ings.  
Alignment And Balance  
Poor suspension alignment may result in:  
5
Fast tire wear.  
Uneven tire wear, such as feathering and one-sided  
wear.  
Never use a tire with a smaller load index or  
capacity, other than what was originally equipped  
on your vehicle. Using a tire with a smaller load  
index could result in tire overloading and failure.  
You could lose control and have an accident.  
Vehicle pull to right or left.  
Tires may also cause the vehicle to pull to the left or right.  
Alignment will not correct this condition. See your dealer  
for proper diagnosis.  
Failure to equip your vehicle with tires having  
adequate speed capability can result in sudden  
tire failure and loss of vehicle control.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
214 STARTING AND OPERATING  
Improper alignment will not cause vehicle vibration.  
Vibration may be a result of tire and wheel out-of-  
balance. Proper balancing will reduce vibration and  
avoid tire cupping and spotty wear.  
SNOW TIRES  
Some areas of the country require the use of snow tires  
during winter. Standard tires are of the all season type  
and satisfy this requirement as indicated by the M+S  
designation on the tire side wall.  
TIRE CHAINS  
If you need snow tires, select tires equivalent in size and  
type to the original equipment tires. Use snow tires only  
in sets of 4, failure to do so may adversely affect the  
safety and handling of your vehicle.  
Due to limited clearance, tire chains are not recom-  
mended.  
CAUTION!  
Snow tires generally have lower speed ratings than what  
was originally equipped with your vehicle and should  
not be operated at sustained speeds over 75 mph (120  
km/ h).  
Damage to the vehicle may result if tire chains are  
used.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 215  
Tire Rotation Recommendations  
Follow the recommended tire rotation frequency for your  
type of driving found in the “Maintenance Schedules”  
Section of this manual. More frequent rotation is permis-  
sible if desired. The suggested rotation method is the  
“forward-cross” shown in the diagram.  
Tires on the front and rear axles of vehicles operate at  
different loads and perform different steering, driving  
and braking functions. For these reasons, they wear at  
unequal rates, and tend to develop irregular wear pat-  
terns.  
These effects can be reduced by timely rotation of tires.  
The benefits of rotation are especially worthwhile with  
aggressive tread designs such as those on all season type  
tires. Rotation will increase tread life, help to maintain  
mud, snow and wet traction levels, and contribute to a  
smooth, quiet ride.  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
216 STARTING AND OPERATING  
FUEL REQUIREMENTS  
The use of high quality unleaded gasoline having an  
octane rating of 91 is recommended but not required.  
High quality unleaded gasoline having a minumum  
octane rating of 87 may safely be used for your vehicle.  
Use of these lower octane gasolines, however, may result  
in reduced acceleration performance.  
2.4L Standard Engine and 2.4L Standard Turbo  
Engine  
Your vehicle is designed to meet all emis-  
sion regulations and provide excellent fuel  
economy when using high quality regular  
unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of  
87. The use of premium gasoline is not  
recommended. The use of premium gaso-  
line will provide no benefit over high quality regular  
gasolines, and in some circumstances, may result in  
poorer performance.  
Light spark knock at low engine speeds is not harmful to  
your engine. However, continued heavy spark knock at  
high speeds can cause damage and immediate service is  
required. Engine damage resulting from operating with a  
heavy spark knock may not be covered by the new  
vehicle warranty.  
2.4L High Output Turbo Engine  
Your engine is designed to meet all emis-  
sion regulations and provide excellent fuel  
economy and performance when using  
high quality unleaded gasoline having an  
octane rating of 91. The purchase of higher  
octane is not required.  
Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such as hard  
starting, stalling and hesitations. If you experience these  
symptoms, try another brand of gasoline (with the ap-  
propriate octane rating for your engine) before consider-  
ing service for the vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 217  
Over 40 automobile manufacturers around the world  
have issued and endorsed consistent gasoline specifica-  
tions (the World Wide Fuel Charter, WWFC) to define  
fuel properties necessary to deliver enhanced emissions,  
engine performance, and durability for your vehicle. The  
manufacturer recommends the use of gasolines that meet  
the WWFC specifications if they are available.  
Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends  
Some fuel suppliers blend unleaded gasoline with oxy-  
genates such as 10% ethanol, MTBE, and ETBE. Oxygen-  
ates are required in some areas of the country during the  
winter months to reduce carbon monoxide emissions.  
Fuels blended with these oxygenates may be used in  
your vehicle.  
Reformulated Gasoline  
Many areas of the country require the use of cleaner  
burning gasoline referred to as “Reformulated Gasoline”.  
CAUTION!  
5
DO NOT use gasolines containing Methanol. Use of  
these blends may result in starting and driveability  
problems and may damage critical fuel system com-  
ponents.  
Reformulated gasolines contain oxygenates, and are spe-  
cifically blended to reduce vehicle emissions and im-  
prove air quality.  
The manufacturer supports the use of reformulated gaso-  
lines. Properly blended reformulated gasolines will pro-  
vide excellent performance and durability of engine and  
fuel system components.  
Problems that result from using methanol/ gasoline  
blends are not the responsibility of the manufacturer and  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
218 STARTING AND OPERATING  
may not be covered by the vehicle warranty. While MTBE  
is an oxygenate made from Methanol, it does not have  
the negative effects of Methanol.  
MMT is prohibited in Federal and California reformu-  
lated gasolines.  
Sulfur In Gasoline  
MMT In Gasoline  
Your vehicle may have been designed to meet California  
low emission standards with cleaner burning California  
reformulated gasoline with low sulfur. This vehicle may  
be sold nationwide. Your vehicle will operate satisfacto-  
rily on fuels meeting Federal specification, but emission  
control system performance may be adversely affected.  
MMT is a manganese containing metallic additive that is  
blended into some gasoline to increase the octane num-  
ber. Gasolines blended with MMT offer no performance  
advantage beyond gasolines of the same octane number  
without MMT. Gasolines blended with MMT have shown  
to reduce spark plug life and reduce emission system  
performance in some vehicles. The manufacturer recom-  
mends using gasolines without MMT. Since the MMT  
content of gasoline may not be indicated on the pump,  
you should ask your gasoline retailer whether or not  
his/ her gasoline contains MMT.  
Gasoline sold outside of California is permitted to have  
higher sulfur levels which may affect the performance of  
the vehicles catalytic converter. This may cause the  
Malfunction Indicator light to illuminate. The manufac-  
turer recommends that you try a different brand of  
unleaded gasoline having lower sulfur to determine if the  
problem is fuel related prior to returning your vehicle to  
an authorized dealer for service.  
It is even more important to look for gasolines without  
MMT in Canada, because MMT can be used at levels  
higher than those allowed in the United States.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 219  
Fuel System Cautions  
CAUTION!  
If the Malfunction Indicator light is flash-  
ing, immediate service is required. See the  
paragraph on the Onboard Diagnostics Sys-  
CAUTION!  
Follow these guidelines to maintain your vehicles  
performance:  
tem in section 7 of this manual.  
Materials Added to Fuel  
The use of leaded gas is prohibited by Federal law.  
Using leaded gasoline can impair engine performance,  
damage the emission control system, and could result  
in loss of warranty coverage.  
All gasoline sold in the United States is required to  
contain effective detergent additives. Use of additional  
detergents or other additives is not needed under normal  
conditions and would result in additional cost. Therefore  
you should not have to add anything to the fuel.  
5
An out-of-tune engine, or certain fuel or ignition  
malfunctions, can cause the catalytic converter to  
overheat. If you notice a pungent burning odor or  
some light smoke, your engine may be out of tune or  
malfunctioning and may require immediate service.  
Contact your dealer for service assistance.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
220 STARTING AND OPERATING  
The use of fuel additives which are now being sold as  
octane enhancers is not recommended. Most of these  
products contain high concentrations of methanol.  
Fuel system damage or vehicle performance problems  
resulting from the use of such fuels or additives is not  
the responsibility of the manufacturer and may not be  
covered under the New Vehicle Warranty.  
Do not inhale exhaust gases. They contain carbon  
monoxide, a colorless and odorless gas which can kill.  
Never run the engine in a closed area, such as a  
garage, and never sit in a parked vehicle with the  
engine running for an extended period. If the vehicle is  
stopped in an open area with the engine running for  
more than a short period, adjust the ventilation system  
to force fresh, outside air into the vehicle.  
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control  
systems can result in civil penalties being assessed  
against you.  
Guard against carbon monoxide with proper mainte-  
nance. Have the exhaust system inspected every time  
the vehicle is raised. Have any abnormal conditions  
repaired promptly. Until repaired, drive with all side  
windows fully open.  
Carbon Monoxide Warnings  
WARNING!  
Keep the liftgate closed when driving your vehicle to  
prevent carbon monoxide and other poisonous ex-  
haust gases from entering the vehicle.  
Carbon monoxide (CO) in exhaust gases is deadly.  
Follow the precautions below to prevent carbon  
monoxide poisoning:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 221  
ADDING FUEL  
CAUTION!  
The fuel tank filler tube has a restricting door about 2  
inches (50 mm) inside the opening. If using a portable  
container, it should have a flexible nozzle long enough to  
force open the restricting door.  
Damage to the fuel system or emission control  
system could result from using an improper fuel  
tank filler tube cap (gas cap). A poorly fitting cap  
could let impurities into the fuel system.  
Fuel Filler Cap (Gas Cap)  
The gas cap is behind the fuel filler door, on the passen-  
gers side of the vehicle. If the gas cap is lost or damaged,  
be sure the replacement cap is for use with this vehicle.  
CAUTION!  
5
NOTE: When removing the fuel filler cap, lay the cap  
tether in the hook, located on the fuel filler cap door  
reinforcement.  
A poorly fitting gas cap may cause the Malfunction  
Indicator Light to turn on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
222 STARTING AND OPERATING  
WARNING!  
CAUTION!  
Remove the fuel tank filler tube cap (gas cap)  
slowly to prevent fuel spray from the filler neck  
which may cause injury.  
To avoid fuel spillage and overfilling, do not “top  
off” the fuel tank after filling.  
The volatility of some gasolines may cause a build  
up of pressure in the fuel tank that may increase  
while you drive. This pressure can result in a  
spray of gasoline and/or vapors when you remove  
the cap from a hot vehicle. Removing the cap  
slowly allows the pressure to vent and prevents  
fuel spray.  
NOTE: When the fuel nozzle “clicks” or shuts off, the  
fuel tank is full.  
Never have any smoking materials lit in or near  
the vehicle when the gas cap is removed or the  
tank filled.  
Never add fuel when the engine is running. This  
is in violation of most state and federal fire  
regulations and will cause the malfunction indi-  
cator light to turn on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 223  
NOTE: Tighten the gas cap about 1/ 4 turn until you  
hear one click. This is an indication that cap is properly  
tightened.  
VEHICLE LOADING  
Vehicle Loading Capacities  
Front Seat Occupants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2  
Rear Seat Occupants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3  
Luggage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 lbs (52 kg)  
Rated Vehicle Capacity. . . . . . . . . . . . . 865 lb (392 kg)  
If the gas cap is not tighten properly, the Malfunction  
Indicator Light will come on. Be sure the gas cap is  
tightened every time the vehicle is refueled.  
TRAILER TOWING  
WARNING!  
In this section you will find safety tips and information  
on limits to the type of towing you can reasonably do  
with your vehicle. Before towing a trailer carefully re-  
view this information to tow your load as efficiently and  
safely as possible.  
5
A fire may result if gasoline is pumped into a  
portable container that is inside of a vehicle. You  
could be burned. Always place gas containers on the  
ground while filling.  
To maintain warranty coverage, follow the requirements  
and recommendations in this manual concerning ve-  
hicles used for trailer towing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
224 STARTING AND OPERATING  
Perform maintenance services as prescribed in the main-  
tenance schedules manual. When your vehicle is used for  
trailer towing, never exceed the gross axle weight rating  
(GAWR) by the addition of:  
If using a manual transaxle vehicle for trailer towing,  
all starts must be in FIRST gear to avoid excessive  
clutch slippage.  
The trailer tongue load must be considered as part of  
the combined weight of occupants and cargo, and  
should never exceed the weight referenced on the Tire  
and Loading Information placard. Refer to the Tire–  
Safety Information Section in this manual.  
The tongue weight of the trailer.  
The weight of any other type of cargo or equipment  
put in or on your vehicle.  
Remember that everything put in or on the trailer adds  
to the load on your vehicle.  
The “D” range can be selected when towing. However,  
if frequent shifting occurs while in this range, the “3”  
range must be selected.  
Warranty Requirements  
The Manufacturers Passenger Vehicle Warranty will  
apply to vehicles used to tow trailers for non-commercial  
use. However the following conditions must be met:  
NOTE: Using the “3” range while operating the vehicle  
under heavy operating conditions will improve perfor-  
mance and extend transaxle life by reducing excessive  
shifting and heat build up.  
The maximum frontal area of the trailer cannot exceed  
20 square feet (1.86 square meters).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STARTING AND OPERATING 225  
NOTE: Check the automatic transaxle fluid level before  
towing.  
WARNING!  
Connecting trailer brakes to your vehicles hydraulic  
brake lines can overload your brake system and  
cause it to fail. You might not have brakes when you  
need them and could have an accident.  
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with Autostick. By using  
the Autostick modes, and selecting a specific gear range,  
frequent shifting can be avoided. The highest gear range  
should be selected that allows for adequate performance.  
For example, choose “4” if the desired speed can be  
maintained. Choose “3” or “2” if needed to maintain the  
desired speed.  
Do not attempt to tow a trailer while using a compact  
spare tire.  
5
Whenever you pull a trailer, regardless of the trailer  
size, stop lights and turn signals on the trailer are  
recommended for motoring safety.  
NOTE: Extended driving at high RPM should be  
avoided to prevent excess heat generation. A reduction in  
vehicle speed may be required to avoid extended driving  
at high RPM. Return to a higher gear range or vehicle  
speed when road conditions and RPM level allows.  
The automatic transaxle fluid and filter should be  
changed if you REGULARLY tow a trailer for more  
than 45 minutes of continuous operation. See Schedule  
B” in section 8 of this manual for transaxle fluid  
change intervals.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES  
CONTENTS  
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
If Your Engine Overheats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
Jacking And Tire Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230  
Jack Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231  
Spare Tire Stowage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231  
Preparations For Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232  
Jacking Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233  
Driving On Slippery Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238  
Acceleration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238  
Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238  
Freeing A Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239  
Towing A Disabled Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240  
With Ignition Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240  
Without The Ignition Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241  
6
Jump-Starting Procedures Due To A Low  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
228 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES  
HAZARD WARNING FLASHER  
Do not use this emergency warning system when the  
vehicle is in motion. Use it when your vehicle is disabled  
and is creating a safety hazard for other motorists.  
If it is necessary to leave the vehicle to go for service, the  
flasher system will continue to operate with the ignition  
key removed and the vehicle locked.  
NOTE: With extended use, the flasher may wear down  
your battery.  
IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS  
In any of the following situations, you can reduce the  
potential for overheating by taking the appropriate ac-  
tion.  
The flasher switch is on top of the steering column,  
just behind the steering wheel. Depress the switch  
and both cluster indicators and all front and rear direc-  
tional signals will flash. Depress the switch again to turn  
Hazard Warning Flashers off.  
On the highways — Slow down.  
In city traffic — While stopped, put transaxle in  
neutral, but do not increase engine idle speed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 229  
If the pointer rises to the H (red) mark, the instrument  
cluster will sound a chime. Pull over and stop the vehicle.  
Idle the vehicle with the air conditioner turned off until  
the pointer drops back into the normal range. If the  
pointer remains on the H (red) mark, turn the engine off  
immediately and call for service.  
CAUTION!  
Driving with a hot cooling system could damage  
your vehicle. If temperature gauge reads “H”, pull  
over and stop the vehicle. Idle the vehicle with the  
air conditioner turned off until the pointer drops  
back into the normal range. After appropriate action  
has been taken, if the pointer remains on the “H”,  
turn the engine off immediately, and call for service.  
NOTE: There are steps that you can take to slow down  
an impending overheat condition. If your air conditioner  
is on, turn it off. The air conditioning system adds heat to  
the engine cooling system and turning off the A/ C  
removes this heat. You can also turn the Temperature  
control to maximum heat, the Mode control to floor, and  
the fan control to High. This allows the heater core to act  
as a supplement to the radiator and aids in removing heat  
from the engine cooling system.  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
230 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES  
JACKING AND TIRE CHANGING  
WARNING!  
A hot engine cooling system is dangerous. You or  
others could be badly burned by steam or boiling  
coolant. You may want to call a service center if your  
vehicle overheats. If you decide to look under the  
hood yourself, refer to Section 7, Maintenance, of  
this manual. Follow the warnings under the Cooling  
System Pressure Cap paragraph.  
WARNING!  
Being under a jacked-up vehicle is dangerous.  
The vehicle could slip off the jack and fall on you.  
You could be crushed. Never put any part of your  
body under a vehicle that is on a jack. Never start  
or run the engine while the vehicle is on a jack. If  
you need to get under a raised vehicle, take it to a  
service center where it can be raised on a lift.  
The jack is designed to use as a tool for changing  
tires only. The jack should not be used to lift the  
vehicle for service purposes. The vehicle should  
be jacked on a firm level surface only. Avoid ice or  
slippery areas.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 231  
Jack Location  
Spare Tire Stowage  
The jack and jack-handle are stowed behind the right rear  
side trim panel in the cargo area.  
The compact spare tire is stowed under the rear of the  
vehicle by means of a hook/ basket mechanism. To re-  
move or stow the compact spare, use the jack handle to  
rotate the “spare tire drive” nut. The nut is located under  
the rear scuff plate at the right rear of the cargo area, just  
inside the liftgate opening.  
6
Do not attempt to raise this vehicle using a bumper jack.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
232 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES  
Spare Tire Removal  
WARNING!  
Lift up the cover and fit the jack-handle over the drive  
nut. Rotate the nut to the left until you can remove the  
swivel hook from the stowage basket. Swing the basket  
down to remove the compact spare tire.  
Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the  
vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough off  
the road to avoid the danger of being hit when  
operating the jack or changing the wheel.  
CAUTION!  
Turn on the Hazard Warning Flasher.  
Block both the front and rear  
The hook is designed for use with the jack handle  
only. Use of an air wrench or other power tools is not  
recommended and can damage the winch.  
of the wheel diagonally oppo-  
site the jacking position. For  
example, if changing the right  
front tire, block the left rear  
wheel.  
Preparations For Jacking  
Park the vehicle on a firm level surface, avoid ice or  
slippery areas, set the parking brake and place the gear  
selector in PARK (automatic transaxle) or REVERSE  
(manual transaxle). Turn OFF the ignition.  
Passengers should not remain in the vehicle while the  
vehicle is being jacked.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 233  
Jacking Instructions  
3. There are two front jacking locations on each side of  
the body and rear jacking locations located on the trailing  
arm bracket under the triangular cut out symbol. Turn  
the jack screw to the right until the jack head is properly  
engaged with the lift area closest to the wheel to be  
changed.  
1. Remove the scissors jack and lug wrench from the  
stowage bag.  
NOTE: If equipped with a center cap that covers the  
wheel nuts, pry off the cap using the small end of the lug  
wrench. To reinstall the cap, make sure it is properly  
lined up before pushing it on to the wheel.  
2. Loosen, but do not remove, the wheel nuts by turning  
them to the left one turn while the wheel is still on the  
ground.  
6
CAUTION!  
Do not attempt to raise the vehicle by jacking on the  
crossmember below the radiator, on the front sus-  
pension crossmember, or on the rear axle assembly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
234 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES  
Do not raise the vehicle until you are sure the jack is  
securely engaged.  
nuts toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the nuts. To avoid  
the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack, do not tighten  
the nuts fully until the vehicle has been lowered.  
4. Raise the vehicle by turning the jack screw to the right,  
using the swivel wrench. Raise the vehicle only until the  
tire just clears the surface and enough clearance is  
obtained to install the spare tire. Minimum tire lift  
provides maximum stability.  
WARNING!  
To avoid possible personal injury, handle the wheel  
covers with care to avoid contact with any sharp  
edges.  
WARNING!  
NOTE: The wheel cover is held on the wheel by the  
wheel nuts. When reinstalling original wheel, properly  
align the wheel cover to the valve stem, place the wheel  
cover onto the wheel, then install the wheel nuts.  
Raising the vehicle higher than necessary can make  
the vehicle less stable. It could slip off the jack and  
hurt someone near it. Raise the vehicle only enough  
to remove the tire.  
6. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack screw to the left.  
5. Remove the wheel nuts and pull the wheel and wheel  
covers where applicable off the hub. Install the spare  
wheel and wheel nuts with the cone shaped end of the  
7. Finish tightening the nuts. Push down on the wrench  
while tightening the wheel nuts. Alternate nuts until each  
nut has been tightened twice. Correct wheel nut torque is  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 235  
100 ft. lbs (135 N·m). If you doubt that you have  
tightened the nuts correctly, have them checked with a  
torque wrench by your dealer or at a service station.  
WARNING!  
A loose tire thrown forward in a collision or hard  
stop could injure the occupants in the vehicle. Have  
the deflated (flat) tire repaired or replaced immedi-  
ately.  
8. Remove the wheel blocks and lower the jack until it is  
free. Stow the lug wrench, and jack in their designated  
location. Secure all parts using the means provided.  
10. Check the tire pressure as soon as possible. Correct  
pressure as required.  
WARNING!  
A loose tire or jack thrown forward in a collision or  
hard stop could endanger the occupants of the ve-  
hicle. Always stow the jack parts and the spare tire in  
the places provided.  
JUMP-STARTING PROCEDURES DUE TO A LOW  
BATTERY  
6
WARNING!  
9. Place the deflated (flat) tire in the cargo area, have the  
tire repaired or replaced as soon as possible.  
Take care to avoid the radiator cooling fan whenever  
the hood is raised. It can start anytime the ignition  
switch is on. You can be hurt by the fan.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
236 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES  
2. When boosting from a battery in another vehicle, park  
that vehicle within booster cable reach but without  
letting the vehicles touch. Set parking brake, place auto-  
matic transaxle in PARK (manual transaxle in NEU-  
TRAL) and turn ignition to OFF for both vehicles.  
WARNING!  
Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to get it  
started. Vehicles equipped with an automatic trans-  
axle cannot be started this way. Unburned fuel could  
enter the catalytic converter and once the engine has  
started, ignite and damage the converter and vehicle.  
If the vehicle has a discharged battery, booster cables  
may be used to obtain a start from another vehicle.  
This type of start can be dangerous if done improp-  
erly, so follow this procedure carefully.  
3. Turn off the heater, radio and all unnecessary electrical  
loads.  
4. Connect one end of a jumper cable to the positive  
terminal of the booster battery. Connect the other end of  
the jumper cable to the positive jump start terminal,  
located near the Power Distribution Center, of the vehicle  
with the discharged battery.  
1. Wear eye protection and remove any metal jewelry  
such as watch bands or bracelets that might make an  
inadvertent electrical contact.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 237  
WARNING!  
Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution; do not  
allow battery fluid to contact eyes, skin or clothing.  
Dont lean over battery when attaching clamps or  
allow the clamps to touch each other. If acid splashes  
in eyes or on skin, flush the contaminated area  
immediately with large quantities of water.  
A battery generates hydrogen gas which is flam-  
mable and explosive. Keep flame or spark away  
from the vent holes. Do not use a booster battery or  
any other booster source with an output that exceeds  
12 volts.  
6
Negative Jump Start  
6. If the vehicle is equipped with Sentry Key Immobi-  
lizer, turn the ignition switch to the ON position for 3  
seconds before moving the ignition switch to the START  
position.  
5. Connect the other cable, first to the negative terminal  
of the booster battery and then to the negative jump start  
terminal, located near the hood release latch, of the  
vehicle with the discharged battery. Make sure you have  
a good contact.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
238 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES  
7. Start the engine in the vehicle that has the booster  
battery, let the engine idle a few minutes, then start the  
engine in the vehicle with the discharged battery.  
WARNING!  
Rapid acceleration on slippery surfaces is danger-  
ous. Unequal traction can cause sudden pulling of  
the front wheels. You could lose control of the  
vehicle and possibly have an accident. Accelerate  
slowly and carefully whenever there is likely to be  
poor traction (ice, snow, wet, mud, loose sand, etc.).  
8. When removing the jumper cables, reverse the se-  
quence exactly. Be careful of the moving belts and fan.  
DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES  
Acceleration  
Rapid acceleration on snow covered, wet, or other slip-  
pery surfaces may cause the front wheels to pull errati-  
cally to the right or left. This phenomenon occurs when  
there is a difference in the surface traction under the front  
(driving) wheels.  
Traction  
When driving on wet or slushy roads, it is possible for a  
wedge of water to build up between the tire and road  
surface. This is hydroplaning and may cause partial or  
complete loss of vehicle control and stopping ability. To  
reduce this possibility, the following precautions should  
be observed:  
1. Slow down during rainstorms or when roads are  
slushy.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 239  
2. Slow down if road has standing water or puddles.  
If your vehicle becomes stuck in mud, sand or snow, it  
can often be moved by a rocking motion. Turn your  
steering wheel right and left to clear the area around the  
front wheels. Then shift back and forth between Reverse  
and First gear. Usually the least accelerator pedal pres-  
sure to maintain the rocking motion without spinning the  
wheels is most effective.  
3. Replace tires when tread wear indicators first become  
visible.  
4. Keep tires properly inflated.  
5. Maintain enough distance between your vehicle and  
the vehicle in front of you to avoid a collision in a sudden  
stop.  
WARNING!  
FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE  
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces gener-  
ated by excessive wheel speeds may cause tire dam-  
age or failure. A tire could explode and injure  
someone. Do not spin your vehicles wheels faster  
than 35 mph (55km/h) when you are stuck. And dont  
let anyone near a spinning wheel, no matter what the  
speed.  
6
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with Traction Con-  
trol, turn the system OFF before attempting to “rock” the  
vehicle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
240 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES  
gear selector must be in NEUTRAL, the distance to be  
towed must not exceed 100 miles (160 km), and the  
towing speed must not exceed 44 mph (72 km/ h). If the  
transaxle is not operative, or if the vehicle is to be towed  
more than 100 miles (160 km), the vehicle must be towed  
with the front wheels off the ground to avoid damage to  
the transaxle.  
CAUTION!  
Racing the engine or spinning the wheels too fast  
may lead to transaxle overheating and failure. It can  
also damage the tires. Do not spin the wheels above  
35 mph (55km/h).  
Manual Transaxle  
TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE  
With Ignition Key  
Your vehicle may be towed if the gearshift lever is in  
NEUTRAL. If the transaxle is not operative, the vehicle  
must be towed with the front wheels off the ground.  
Four Speed Automatic Transaxle  
Your vehicle may be towed under the following condi-  
tions: The steering column must be unlocked and the  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 241  
All Transaxles  
Without The Ignition Key  
Special care must be taken when the vehicle is towed  
with the ignition in the LOCK position. A dolly should be  
used under the front wheels if the rear wheels are raised.  
Proper towing equipment is necessary to prevent dam-  
age to the vehicle.  
CAUTION!  
If the vehicle being towed requires steering, the  
ignition switch must be in the OFF position, not in  
the LOCK or ACCESSORY positions.  
Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle (Flat  
Towing With All Four Wheels On The Ground)  
If your vehicle is equipped with a manual transaxle, it  
may be towed at any legal highway speed, for any  
distance, if the transaxle is in neutral.  
Do not attempt to use sling type equipment when  
towing. When securing vehicle to flat bed truck, do  
not attach to front or rear suspension components.  
Damage to your vehicle may result from improper  
towing.  
6
If the ignition key is not available, vehicles with auto-  
matic transaxles can not be flat towed at any time.  
If it is necessary to use the accessories while being towed  
(wipers, defrosters, etc.), the key must be in the ON  
position, not the ACCESSORY position. Make certain the  
transaxle remains in NEUTRAL.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
CONTENTS  
2.4L High Output Turbo Engine Compartment . . 246  
2.4L Engine Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247  
Onboard Diagnostic System — OBD II . . . . . . . . 248  
Drive Belts — Check Condition And Tension . . 256  
Spark Plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
Ignition Wiring System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
Catalytic Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
Engine Timing Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258  
Crankcase Emission Control System . . . . . . . . 258  
Fuel Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258  
Air Cleaner Element (Filter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258  
Maintenance-Free Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259  
Emissions Inspection And Maintenance  
Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249  
7
Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250  
Dealer Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250  
Maintenance Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251  
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
244 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
Air Conditioner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261  
Power Steering — Fluid Check . . . . . . . . . . . . 261  
Front Suspension Ball Joints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262  
Body Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262  
Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263  
Windshield Washer Reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264  
Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265  
Hoses And Vacuum/ Vapor Harnesses . . . . . . . 269  
Fuel System Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270  
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270  
Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273  
Manual Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276  
Appearance Care And Protection From  
Corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276  
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282  
Underhood Fuses  
(Power Distribution Center) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282  
Interior Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285  
Vehicle Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285  
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287  
Headlight Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287  
Front Park/ Turn Signal/ Side Marker Lights . . 288  
Front Fog Lights — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . 288  
Tail/ Stop, And Rear Turn Signal Lights . . . . . . 288  
Back Up Light Bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 245  
Center High Mounted Stop Light . . . . . . . . . . 289  
Fluids And Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291  
Chassis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292  
Recommended Fluids, Lubricants And Genuine  
Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
246 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
2.4L HIGH OUTPUT TURBO ENGINE COMPARTMENT  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 247  
2.4L ENGINE COMPARTMENT  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
248 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD II  
CAUTION!  
Your vehicle is equipped with a sophisticated onboard  
diagnostic system called OBD II. This system monitors  
the performance of the emissions, engine, and automatic  
transmission control systems. When these systems are  
operating properly, your vehicle will provide excellent  
performance and fuel economy, as well as engine emis-  
sions well within current government regulations.  
Prolonged driving with the “Malfunction Indica-  
tor Light” on could cause further damage to the  
emission control system. It could also affect fuel  
economy and driveability. The vehicle must be  
serviced before any emissions tests can be per-  
formed.  
If any of these systems require service, the OBD II system  
will turn on the “Malfunction Indicator Light.” It will  
also store diagnostic codes and other information to  
assist your service technician in making repairs. Al-  
though your vehicle will usually be drivable and not  
need towing, see your dealer for service as soon as  
possible.  
If the “Malfunction Indicator Light” is flashing  
while the engine is running, severe catalytic con-  
verter damage and power loss will soon occur.  
Immediate service is required.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 249  
EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
PROGRAMS  
In some localities, it may be a legal requirement to pass  
an inspection of your vehicles emissions control system.  
Failure to pass could prevent vehicle registration.  
Your vehicle has a simple ignition key actuated test  
which you can use prior to going to the test station. To  
check if your vehicles OBD system is ready, you must do  
the following:  
1. Insert your ignition key into the ignition switch.  
For states which have an I/ M (Inspection and  
Maintenance) requirement, this check verifies the  
following: the MIL (Malfunction Indicator Lamp)  
is functioning and is not on when the engine is running,  
and that the OBD (On Board Diagnostic) system is ready  
for testing.  
2. Turn the ignition to the ON position, but do not crank  
or start the engine.  
3. If you crank or start the engine, you will have to start  
this test over.  
4. As soon as you turn your key to the ON position, you  
will see your MIL symbol come on as part of a normal  
bulb check.  
Normally, the OBD system will be ready. The OBD  
system may not be ready if your vehicle was recently  
serviced, if you recently had a dead battery, or a battery  
replacement. If the OBD system should be determined  
not ready for the I/ M test, your vehicle may fail the test.  
7
5. Approximately 15 seconds later, one of two things will  
happen:  
a. The MIL will flash for about 10 seconds and then  
return to being fully illuminated until you turn off the  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
250 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
ignition key or start the engine. This means that your  
vehicle’s OBD system is not ready and you should not  
proceed to the I/ M station.  
vehicle serviced before going to the I/ M station. The I/ M  
station can fail your vehicle because the MIL symbol is on  
with the engine running.  
b. The MIL will not flash at all and will remain fully  
illuminated until you turn off the ignition key or start  
the engine. This means that your vehicles OBD system  
is ready and you can proceed to the I/ M station.  
REPLACEMENT PARTS  
Use of genuine Moparparts for normal/ scheduled  
maintenance and repairs is highly recommended to in-  
sure the designed performance. Damage or failures  
caused by the use of non-Moparparts for maintenance  
and repairs will not be covered by the manufacturers  
warranty.  
If your OBD system is not ready, you should see your  
authorized dealer or repair facility. If your vehicle was  
recently serviced or had a battery failure or replacement,  
you may need to do nothing more than drive your  
vehicle as you normally would in order for your OBD  
system to update. A recheck with the above test routine  
may then indicate that the system is now ready.  
DEALER SERVICE  
Your dealer has the qualified service personnel, special  
tools and equipment to perform all service operations in  
an expert manner. Service Manuals are available which  
include detailed service information for your vehicle.  
Refer to these manuals before attempting any procedure  
yourself.  
Regardless of whether your vehicles OBD system is  
ready or not ready, if the MIL symbol is illuminated  
during normal vehicle operation, you should have your  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 251  
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control  
systems can result in civil penalties being assessed  
against you.  
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES  
The pages that follow contain the required maintenance  
services determined by the engineers who designed your  
vehicle.  
WARNING!  
Besides the maintenance items for which there are fixed  
maintenance intervals, there are other items that should  
operate satisfactorily without periodic maintenance.  
However, if a malfunction of these items does occur, it  
could adversely affect the engine or vehicle performance.  
These items should be inspected if a malfunction is  
observed or suspected.  
You can be badly injured working on or around a  
motor vehicle. Do only that service work for which  
you have the knowledge and the proper equipment.  
If you have any doubt about your ability to perform  
a service job, take your vehicle to a competent  
mechanic.  
Engine Oil  
7
Checking Oil Level  
To assure proper engine lubrication, the engine oil must  
be maintained at the correct level. Check the oil level at  
regular intervals, such as every fuel stop.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
252 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
The best time to check the engine oil level is about 5  
minutes after a fully warmed engine is shut off or before  
starting the engine after it has sat overnight.  
dipstick. Adding one quart of oil when the reading is at  
the MIN mark will result in a MAX reading on these  
engines.  
CAUTION!  
Overfilling the crankcase as indicated by an oil level  
above the “Max” mark on the engine oil dipstick  
will cause oil aeration, which can lead to loss of oil  
pressure and an increase in oil temperature. This  
could damage your engine.  
Change Engine Oil  
Road conditions and your kind of driving affects the  
interval at which your oil should be changed. Check the  
following list to decide if any apply to you.  
Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground, will  
improve the accuracy of the oil level readings. Maintain  
the oil level between the MIN and MAX markings on the  
Day and night temperatures are below 32°F (0°C).  
Stop and Go driving.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 253  
Extensive engine idling.  
change your engine oil at every interval shown on  
schedule “A”—NON TURBO CHARGED ENGINES in  
the maintenance schedule section of this manual.  
Driving in dusty conditions.  
Short trips of less than 10 miles (16 km).  
If none of these apply to you, and your vehicle is  
equipped with a Turbo Charged Engine change your  
engine oil at every interval shown on schedule  
“A”—TURBO CHARGED ENGINES in the maintenance  
schedule section of this manual.  
More than 50% of your driving is at sustained high  
speeds during hot weather, above 90°F (32°C).  
Trailer towing.  
Taxi, Police or delivery service (commercial service).  
Off-Road or desert operation.  
NOTE: Under no circumstances should oil change in-  
tervals exceed 6000 miles (10 000 km) or 6 months  
whichever comes first.  
NOTE: If ANY of these apply to you, then change your  
engine oil every 3,000 miles (4 800 km) or 3 months,  
whichever comes first and follow maintenance schedule  
B—ALL ENGINES in the maintenance schedule sec-  
tion of this manual.  
Engine Oil Selection  
7
For best performance and maximum protection under all  
types of operating conditions, the manufacturer only  
recommends engine oils that are API certified and meet  
the requirements of DaimlerChrysler Material Standard  
MS-6395.  
If none of these apply to you, and your vehicle is  
equipped with a Non–Turbo Charged Engine then  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
254 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
American Petroleum Institute (API) Engine Oil  
Identification Symbol  
This symbol means that the oil has  
been certified by the American  
Petroleum Institute (API). The  
manufacturer only recommends  
API Certified engine oils.  
Engine Oil Viscosity (SAE Grade)  
The proper SAE viscosity grade of engine oil should be  
selected based on the following recommendation and be  
within the operating temperature shown in the engine oil  
viscosity chart.  
SAE 5W-30 engine oil is preferred. SAE 5W-30 engine  
oils improve low temperature starting and helps ve-  
hicle fuel economy.  
Lubricants which do not have both, the engine oil certi-  
fication mark and the correct SAE viscosity grade num-  
ber should not be used.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 255  
Synthetic Engine Oils  
dealer, service station, or governmental agency for advice  
on how and where used oil can be safely discarded in  
your area.  
There are a number of engine oils being promoted as  
either synthetic or semi-synthetic. If you chose to use  
such a product, use only those oils that are American  
Petroleum Institute (API) Certified and SAE viscosity  
standard. Follow the service schedule that describes your  
driving type.  
Engine Oil Filter  
The engine oil filter should be replaced at every engine  
oil change.  
Engine Oil Filter Selection  
Materials Added To Engine Oils  
All of this manufacturers engines have a full-flow type  
disposable oil filter. Use a filter of this type for replace-  
ment. The quality of replacement filters varies consider-  
ably. Only high quality filters should be used to assure  
most efficient service. Mopar Engine Oil Filters are high  
quality oil filters and are recommended.  
The manufacture strongly recommends against the addi-  
tion of any additives (other than leak detection dyes) to  
the engine oil. Engine oil is an engineered product and  
it’s performance may be impaired by supplemental ad-  
ditives.  
7
Disposing of Used Engine Oil  
Care should be taken in disposing of used engine oil from  
your vehicle. Used oil, indiscriminately discarded, can  
present a problem to the environment. Contact your  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
256 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
Drive Belts — Check Condition and Tension  
plug. Refer to the Engine data Label located under the  
hood for the proper type of spark plug for use in your  
vehicle.  
At the mileage shown in the maintenance schedules,  
check all drive belts for condition and proper tension.  
Improper belt tension can cause belt slippage and failure.  
Ignition Wiring System  
Inspect the drive belts for evidence of cuts, cracks, or  
glazing and replace them if there is any sign of damage  
which could result in belt failure. If adjustment is re-  
quired, see your authorized dealer for service.  
The ignition cables should be kept clean and properly  
connected. Terminals should be fully seated. Cracked,  
damaged, or faulty cables should be replaced.  
Catalytic Converter  
Special tools are required to properly measure tension  
and to restore belt tension to factory specifications. Also,  
check belt routing to make sure there is no interference  
between the belts and other engine components.  
The catalytic converter requires the use of unleaded fuel  
only. Leaded gasoline will destroy the effectiveness of the  
catalyst as an emission control device.  
Under normal operating conditions, the catalytic con-  
verter will not require maintenance. However, it is im-  
portant to keep the engine properly tuned to assure  
proper catalyst operation and prevent possible catalyst  
damage.  
Spark Plugs  
Spark plugs must fire properly to assure engine perfor-  
mance and emission control. New plugs should be in-  
stalled at the specified mileage. The entire set should be  
replaced if there is any malfunction due to a faulty spark  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 257  
WARNING!  
CAUTION!  
A hot exhaust system can start a fire if you park over  
materials that can burn. Such materials might be  
grass or leaves coming into contact with your ex-  
haust system. Do not park or operate your vehicle in  
areas where your exhaust system can contact any-  
thing that can burn.  
Damage to the catalytic converter can result if your  
vehicle is not kept in proper operating condition. In  
the event of engine malfunction, particularly involv-  
ing engine misfire or other apparent loss of perfor-  
mance, have your vehicle serviced promptly. Contin-  
ued operation of your vehicle with  
a
severe  
malfunction could cause the converter to overheat,  
resulting in possible damage to the converter and the  
vehicle.  
In unusual situations involving grossly malfunctioning  
engine operation, a scorching odor may suggest severe  
and abnormal catalyst overheating. If this occurs, stop  
the vehicle, turn off the engine and allow it to cool.  
Service, including a tune up to manufacturers specifica-  
tions, should be obtained immediately.  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
258 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
To minimize the possibility of catalyst damage:  
accumulate deposits. If a valve is not working properly,  
replace it with a new valve. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO  
CLEAN THE OLD PCV VALVE!  
Do not shut off the engine or interrupt the ignition  
when the transaxle is in gear and the vehicle is in  
motion.  
Check ventilation hose for indication of damage or  
plugging deposits. Replace if necessary.  
Do not try to start the engine by pushing or towing the  
vehicle.  
Fuel Filter  
A plugged fuel filter can cause hard starting or limit the  
speed at which a vehicle can be driven. Should an  
excessive amount of dirt accumulate in the fuel tank,  
frequent filter replacement may be necessary. The fuel  
filters are located inside the fuel tank. See your dealer for  
service.  
Do not idle the engine with any spark plug wires  
disconnected for prolonged period.  
Engine Timing Belt  
Replace the engine timing belt at the intervals described  
in the appropriate maintenance schedule.  
Crankcase Emission Control System  
Air Cleaner Element (Filter)  
Proper operation of this system depends on freedom  
from sticking or plugging due to deposits. As vehicle  
mileage builds up, the PCV valve and passages may  
Under normal driving conditions, replace the filter at the  
intervals shown on Schedule “A”. If, however, you drive  
the vehicle frequently under dusty or severe conditions,  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 259  
the filter element should be inspected periodically and  
replaced if necessary at the intervals shown on Schedule  
B.  
Maintenance-Free Battery  
You will never have to add water, nor is periodic main-  
tenance required.  
WARNING!  
CAUTION!  
The air cleaner can provide a measure of protection  
in the case of engine backfire. Do not remove the air  
cleaner unless such removal is necessary for repair or  
maintenance. Make sure that no one is near the  
engine compartment before starting the vehicle with  
the air cleaner removed. Failure to do so can result in  
serious personal injury.  
When servicing the battery, always reinstall the  
battery thermowrap. The thermowrap provides bat-  
tery heat protection and will extend overall battery  
life. Failure to reinstall the thermowrap can result in  
evaporative loss of the battery fluid.  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
260 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
WARNING!  
CAUTION!  
Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution and can  
burn or even blind you. Dont allow battery fluid to  
contact your eyes, skin or clothing. Dont lean over a  
battery when attaching clamps. If acid splashes in  
eyes or on skin, flush the area immediately with  
large amounts of water.  
It is essential when replacing the cables on the  
battery that the positive cable is attached to the  
positive post and the negative cable is attached to the  
negative post. Battery posts are marked positive (+)  
and negative (-) and identified on the battery case.  
Cable clamps should be tight on the terminal posts  
and free of corrosion. Apply grease to posts and  
clamps after tightening.  
Battery gas is flammable and explosive. Keep flame  
or sparks away from the battery. Dont use a booster  
battery or any other booster source with an output  
greater than 12 volts. Dont allow cable clamps to  
touch each other.  
If a “fast charger” is used while the battery is in the  
vehicle, disconnect both vehicle battery cables be-  
fore connecting the charger to battery. Do not use a  
“fast charger” to provide starting voltage as battery  
damage can result.  
Battery posts, terminals and related accessories con-  
tain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands after  
handling.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 261  
Air Conditioner  
Refrigerant Recovery And Recycling  
Check the air conditioning system at the start of the  
warm weather season.  
The air conditioning system of your vehicle contains  
R-134a, a refrigerant that does not deplete the ozone layer  
in the upper atmosphere, the manufacturer recommends  
that air conditioning service be done by facilities using  
refrigerant recycling and recovery equipment that meets  
SAE standard J1991.  
NOTE: If your air conditioning performance seems  
lower than expected, check the front of the A/ C con-  
denser for an accumulation of dirt or insects. Clean with  
a gentle water spray from behind the radiator and  
through the condenser as required. Fabric front fascia  
protectors may reduce air flow to the condenser, reducing  
air conditioning performance.  
Power Steering — Fluid Check  
Checking the power steering fluid level at a defined  
service interval is not required. The fluid should only be  
checked if a leak is suspected, abnormal noises are  
apparent, and/ or the system is not functioning as antici-  
pated. Coordinate inspection efforts through a certified  
DaimlerChrysler Dealership.Љ  
WARNING!  
7
The air conditioning system contains refrigerant  
under high pressure. To avoid risk of personal injury  
or damage to the system, adding refrigerant or any  
repair requiring lines to be disconnected should be  
done by an experienced repairman.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
262 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
Body Lubrication  
WARNING!  
Locks and all body pivot points, including such items as  
seat tracks, doors,liftgate and hood hinges, should be  
lubricated periodically to assure quiet, easy operation  
and to protect against rust and wear. Prior to the appli-  
cation of any lubricant, the parts concerned should be  
wiped clean to remove dust and grit; after lubricating  
excess oil and grease should be removed. Particular  
attention should also be given to hood latching compo-  
nents to insure proper function. When performing other  
underhood services, the hood latch, release mechanism  
and safety catch should be cleaned and lubricated.  
Fluid level should be checked on a level surface and  
with the engine off to prevent injury from moving  
parts and to insure accurate fluid level reading. Do  
not overfill. Use only manufacturers recommended  
power steering fluid.  
If necessary, add fluid to restore to the proper indicated  
level. With a clean cloth, wipe any spilled fluid from all  
surfaces. Refer to Recommended Fluids, Lubricants, and  
Genuine Parts for correct fluid types.  
The external lock cylinders should be lubricated twice a  
year, preferably in the fall and spring. Apply a small  
amount of a high quality lubricant such as MoparLock  
Cylinder Lubricant directly into the lock cylinder.  
Front Suspension Ball Joints  
There are two front suspension lower ball joints that are  
permanently lubricated. Inspect these ball joints when-  
ever under vehicle service is done. Damaged seals and  
their corresponding potentially damaged ball joints must  
be replaced.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 263  
Windshield Wiper Blades  
2. Push the release tab shown in the illustration and slide  
the wiper blade assembly down along the arm. Gently  
place the wiper arm on the windshield.  
Clean the rubber edges of the wiper blades and the  
windshield periodically with a sponge or soft cloth and a  
mild non abrasive cleaner or use the washer solvent. This  
will remove accumulations of salt, waxes or road film  
and help reduce streaking and smearing.  
3. Install the new blade assembly onto the wiper arm tip  
until it locks in place.  
Operation of the wipers on dry glass for long periods  
may cause deterioration of the wiper blades. Always use  
washer fluid when using the wipers to remove salt or dirt  
from a dry windshield. Avoid using the wiper blades to  
remove frost or ice from the windshield. make sure that  
they are not frozen to the glass before turning them on to  
avoid damaging the blade. Keep the blade rubber out of  
contact with petroleum products such as engine oil,  
gasoline, etc.  
7
Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement  
1. Lift the wiper arm away from the glass.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
264 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
Windshield Washer Reservoir  
Exhaust System  
The washer fluid reservoir is located in the rear of the  
engine compartment on the passenger side and should be  
checked for fluid level at regular intervals. Fill the  
reservoir with windshield washer solvent (not radiator  
antifreeze).  
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into  
the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust  
system.  
If you notice a change in the sound of the exhaust system,  
or if exhaust fumes can be detected inside the vehicle, or  
when the underside or rear of the vehicle is damaged;  
have a competent technician inspect the complete ex-  
haust system and adjacent body areas for broken, dam-  
aged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open seams  
or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes to seep  
into the passenger compartment. In addition, inspect the  
exhaust system each time the vehicle is raised for an oil  
change or lubrication. Replace as required.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 265  
Cooling System  
WARNING!  
Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain carbon  
monoxide which is colorless and odorless. Breathing  
it can make you unconscious and can eventually  
poison you. Follow the above precautions to keep  
your exhaust system as safe as possible.  
WARNING!  
When working near the radiator cooling fan, dis-  
connect the fan motor lead or turn the ignition  
switch to the OFF position. The fan is temperature  
controlled and can start at any time the ignition  
switch is in the ON position.  
You or others can be badly burned by hot coolant  
or steam from your radiator. If you see or hear  
steam coming from under the hood, dont open  
the hood until the radiator has had time to cool.  
Never try to open a cooling system pressure cap  
when the radiator is hot.  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
266 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
Coolant Checks  
Cooling System — Drain, Flush And Refill  
At the intervals shown on the Maintenance Schedules,  
the system should be drained, flushed and refilled.  
Check coolant protection every 12 months (before the  
onset of freezing weather, where applicable). If coolant is  
dirty or rusty in appearance, the system should be  
drained, flushed and refilled with fresh coolant.  
If the solution is dirty and contains a considerable  
amount of sediment, clean and flush with a reliable  
cooling system cleaner. Follow with a thorough rinsing to  
remove all deposits and chemicals. Discard old antifreeze  
solution.  
Check the front of the radiator for an accumulation of  
bugs, leaves, etc. Clean the radiator by gently spraying  
water from a garden hose at the back of the core.  
Check the coolant recovery bottle tubing for brittle rubber,  
cracking, tears, cuts and tightness of the connection at the  
bottle and radiator. Inspect the entire system for leaks.  
Engine Coolant Disposal  
Used ethylene glycol based engine coolant is a regulated  
substance requiring proper disposal. Check with your  
local authorities to determine the disposal rules for your  
community. To prevent ingestion by animals or children  
do not store ethylene glycol based engine coolant in open  
containers or allow it to remain in puddles on the  
ground. If ingested by a child, contact a physician  
immediately. Clean up any ground spills immediately.  
With the engine at normal operating temperature (but  
not running), check the cooling system pressure cap for  
proper vacuum sealing by draining a small amount of  
coolant from the radiator drain cock. If the cap is sealing  
properly, the coolant will begin to drain from the coolant  
recovery bottle. Do not remove the cap when the cooling  
system is hot.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 267  
Selection Of Coolant  
Use higher concentrations (not to exceed 70%) if tempera-  
Use only the manufacturers recommended coolant, refer  
to Recommended Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts  
for correct coolant type.  
tures belowϪ34°F ( Ϫ37°C) are anticipated.  
Use only high purity water such as distilled or deionized  
water when mixing the water/ antifreeze solution. The  
use of lower quality water will reduce the amount of  
corrosion protection in the engine cooling system.  
CAUTION!  
Please note that it is the owners responsibility to main-  
tain the proper level of protection against freezing ac-  
cording to the temperatures occurring in the area where  
the vehicle is operated.  
Failure to use the proper antifreeze could cause  
radiator plugging and engine overheating. Do not  
mix antifreeze brands or use plain water alone or  
alcohol based antifreeze products. Do not use addi-  
tional rust inhibitors or antirust products, as they  
may not be compatible with the radiator coolant and  
may plug the radiator.  
NOTE: Mixing coolant types will decrease the life of the  
engine coolant and will require more frequent coolant  
changes.  
7
Cooling System Pressure Cap  
Adding Coolant  
When adding coolant, a minimum solution of 50% eth-  
ylene glycol antifreeze coolant in water should be used.  
The cap must be fully tightened to prevent loss of  
coolant, and to insure that coolant will return to the  
radiator from the coolant recovery bottle.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
268 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
The cap should be inspected and cleaned if there is any  
accumulation of foreign material on the sealing surfaces.  
operating temperature, the level of the coolant in the  
bottle should be between the “FULL” and “ADD” marks.  
The radiator normally remains completely full, so there is  
no need to remove the radiator cap unless checking for  
coolant freeze point or replacing coolant. Advise your  
service attendant of this. As long as the engine operating  
temperature is satisfactory, the coolant recovery bottle  
need only be checked once a month.  
WARNING!  
The warning words “DO NOT OPEN HOT” on the  
cooling system pressure cap are a safety precaution.  
Never add coolant when the engine is overheated.  
Do not loosen or remove the cap to cool an over-  
heated engine. Heat causes pressure to build up in  
the cooling system. To prevent scalding or injury, do  
not remove the pressure cap while the system is hot  
or under pressure.  
When additional coolant is needed to maintain the  
proper level, it should be added to the coolant recovery  
bottle. Do not overfill.  
Points To Remember  
NOTE: When the vehicle is stopped after a few kilome-  
ters (a few miles) of operation, you may observe vapor  
coming from the front of the engine compartment. This is  
normally a result of moisture from rain, snow, or high  
Coolant Level  
The coolant recovery bottle provides a quick visual  
method for determining that the coolant level is ad-  
equate. With the engine idling, and warm to normal  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 269  
humidity accumulation on the radiator and being vapor-  
ized when the thermostat opens, allowing hot water to  
enter the radiator.  
Keep the front of the radiator clean. If your vehicle has  
air conditioning, keep the front of the condenser clean,  
also.  
If an examination of your engine compartment shows no  
evidence of radiator or hose leaks, the vehicle may be  
safely driven. The vapor will soon dissipate.  
Do not change the thermostat for summer or winter  
operation. If replacement is ever necessary, install  
ONLY the correct type thermostat. Other designs may  
result in unsatisfactory coolant performance, poor gas  
mileage, and increased emissions.  
Do not overfill the coolant recovery bottle.  
Check coolant freeze point in the system.  
Hoses And Vacuum/Vapor Harnesses  
If frequent coolant additions are required, the cooling  
system should be pressure tested for leaks.  
Inspect surfaces of hoses and nylon tubing for evidence  
of heat and mechanical damage. Hard or soft spots,  
brittle rubber, cracking, tears, cuts, abrasions, and exces-  
sive swelling indicate deterioration of the rubber  
Maintain coolant concentration at 50% ethylene glycol  
antifreeze (minimum) in water for proper corrosion  
protection of your engine which contains aluminum  
components.  
7
Pay particular attention to the hoses nearest to high heat  
sources such as the exhaust manifold. Inspect hose rout-  
ing to be sure hoses do not touch any heat source or  
moving component that may cause heat damage or  
mechanical wear.  
Make sure that the radiator and coolant recovery  
bottle hoses are not kinked or obstructed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
270 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
Insure nylon tubing in these areas has not melted or  
collapsed  
Brake System  
In order to assure brake system performance, all brake  
system components should be inspected periodically.  
Suggested service intervals can be found in the Mainte-  
nance Section.  
Inspect all hose connections such as clamps and cou-  
plings to make sure the are secure and no leaks are  
present.  
Components should be replaced immediately if there is  
any evidence of degradation that could cause failure.  
WARNING!  
Riding the brakes can lead to brake failure and  
possibly an accident. Driving with your foot resting  
or riding on the brake pedal can result in abnormally  
high brake temperatures, excessive lining wear, and  
possible brake damage. You wouldnt have your full  
braking capacity in an emergency.  
Fuel System Connections  
Electronic Fuel Injection high pressure fuel systems are  
designed with tubes and special connects, connections  
and clamps which have unique material characteristics to  
provide adequate sealing and resist attack by deterio-  
rated gasoline.  
You are urged to use only the manufactures-specified  
tubes, connections and clamps, or their equivalent in  
material and specification, in any fuel system servicing.  
Brake And Power Steering System Hoses  
When servicing the vehicle for scheduled maintenance,  
inspect the surface of the hoses and nylon tubing for  
evidence of heat and mechanical damage. Hard and  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 271  
brittle rubber, cracking, tears, cuts, abrasions, and exces-  
sive swelling suggest deterioration of the rubber. Particu-  
lar attention should be made to examining those hose  
surfaces nearest to high heat sources, such as the exhaust  
manifold.  
NOTE: Inspection of brake hoses should be done when-  
ever the brake system is serviced and at every engine oil  
change.  
WARNING!  
Inspect all hose clamps and couplings to make sure they  
are secure and no leaks are present.  
Worn brake hoses can burst and cause brake failure.  
You could have an accident. If you see any signs of  
cracking, scuffing, or worn spots, have the brake  
hoses replaced immediately.  
Insure nylon tubing in these areas has not melted or  
collapsed.  
NOTE: Often, fluids such as oil, power steering fluid,  
and brake fluid are used during assembly plant opera-  
tions to ease the assembly of hoses to couplings. There-  
fore, oil wetness at the hose-coupling area is not neces-  
sarily an indication of leakage. Actual dripping of hot  
fluid when systems are under pressure (during vehicle  
operation) should be noted before a hose is replaced  
based on leakage.  
Brake Master Cylinder  
The fluid level in the master cylinder should be checked  
when performing under hood services, or immediately if  
the brake system warning lamp is on.  
7
Be sure to clean the top of the master cylinder area before  
removing the cap. If necessary, add fluid to bring the  
fluid level up to the requirements described on the brake  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
272 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
fluid reservoir. Fluid level can be expected to fall as the  
brake pads wear. Brake fluid level should be checked  
when pads are replaced. However, low fluid level may be  
caused by a leak and a checkup may be needed.  
WARNING!  
Use of a brake fluid that may have a lower initial  
boiling point or unidentified as to specification, may  
result in sudden brake failure during hard pro-  
longed braking. You could have an accident.  
WARNING!  
Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in  
spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts and the  
brake fluid catching fire.  
Use only brake fluid that has been in a tightly closed  
container to avoid contamination from foreign matter.  
Use only manufacturers recommended brake fluid, refer  
to Recommended Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts  
for correct fluid type.  
Do not allow petroleum based fluid to contaminate the  
brake fluid as seal damage will result!  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 273  
Automatic Transaxle  
All front wheel drive vehicles have a transmission and  
differential assembly contained within a single housing.  
CAUTION!  
Using a transmission fluid other than the manufac-  
turers recommended fluid may cause deterioration  
in transmission shift quality and/or torque converter  
shudder. Using a transmission fluid other than the  
manufacturers recommended fluid will result in  
more frequent fluid and filter changes. Refer to  
Recommended Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts  
for correct fluid type.  
Selection Of Lubricant  
It is important that the proper lubricant is used in the  
transaxle to assure optimum transaxle performance. Use  
only manufacturers recommended transmission fluid,  
refer to Recommended Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine  
Parts for correct fluid type. It is important that the  
transmission fluid be maintained at the prescribed level  
using the recommended fluid.  
Fluid Level Check  
7
The fluid level in the automatic transaxle should be  
checked whenever the vehicle is serviced. Operation with  
an improper fluid level will greatly reduce the life of the  
transaxle and of the fluid.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
274 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
Procedure For Checking Fluid Level  
To properly check the automatic transaxle fluid level, the  
following procedure must be used:  
1. The vehicle must be on level ground.  
2. The engine should be running at curb idle speed for a  
minimum of 60 seconds.  
3. Fully apply parking brake.  
4. Place the gear selector momentarily in each gear  
position ending with the lever in P (PARK).  
5. Remove the dipstick and determine if the fluid is hot  
or warm. Hot fluid is approximately 180°F (82°C) which  
is the normal operating temperature after the vehicle has  
been driven at least 24 km (15 miles). The fluid cannot be  
comfortable held between the finger tips. Warm is when  
the fluid is between 85° to 125°F (29° to 52°C).  
6. Wipe the dipstick clean and reinsert until seated.  
Remove dipstick and note reading.  
If the fluid is hot, reading should be in the cross hatched  
area marked “HOT” between the upper two holes in the  
dipstick.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 275  
If the fluid is cold, the fluid level should be between the  
lower two holes, into the area marked “LOW”.  
Maintenance schedule “A”—Non Turbo Charged En-  
gines No change necessary.  
If the fluid level shows low, add sufficient transmission  
fluid to bring to the proper level.  
Maintenance schedule “A”—Turbo Charged Engines –  
No change necessary.  
Maintenance schedule “B”—All Engines – Every 60,000  
miles (96 000 km) change fluid and filter under the  
following conditions:  
CAUTION!  
Do not overfill. Dirt and water in the transaxle can  
cause serious damage. To prevent dirt and water  
from entering the transaxle after checking or replen-  
ishing fluid, make certain that the dipstick cap is  
seated properly.  
Police, taxi, limousine, commercial type operation, or  
trailer towing where the vehicle is driven regularly for  
more than 45 minutes of continuous operation.  
NOTE: Refer to Section 8 of this manual for mainte-  
7
nance schedules.  
Fluid And Filter Changes  
Automatic transmission fluid and filter should be  
changed as follows:  
If the transaxle is disassembled for any reason, the fluid  
and filter should be changed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
276 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
Special Additives  
Frequency Of Fluid Change  
The manufacturer recommends against the addition of  
any fluid additives to the transaxle. The only exception to  
this policy is the use of special dyes to aid in detecting  
fluid leaks. The use of transmission sealers should be  
avoided as they may adversely affect seals.  
Under normal operating conditions, the fluid installed at  
the factory will give satisfactory lubrication for the life of  
the vehicle. Fluid changes are not necessary unless the  
following conditions exist:  
The lubricant has become contaminated with water. If  
contaminated with water, the fluid should be changed  
immediately.  
Manual Transaxle  
Lubricant Selection  
Use only manufacturers recommended transmission  
fluid, refer to Recommended Fluids, Lubricants and  
Genuine Parts for correct fluid type.  
If severe usage has occurred, refer to Maintenance  
Schedule “B” in Section 8 of this manual.  
Appearance Care And Protection From Corrosion  
Fluid Level Check  
Protection Of Body And Paint from Corrosion  
Check the fluid level by removing the fill plug. The fluid  
level should be between the bottom of the fill hole and a  
point not more that 3/ 16” (4.7 mm) below the bottom of  
the hole.  
Vehicle body care requirements vary according to geo-  
graphic locations and usage. Chemicals that make roads  
passable in snow and ice, and those that are sprayed on  
trees and road surfaces during other seasons, are highly  
corrosive to the metal in your vehicle. Outside parking,  
Add fluid, if necessary, to maintain the proper level.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 277  
which exposes your vehicle to airborne contaminants,  
road surfaces on which the vehicle is operated, extreme  
hot or cold weather and other extreme conditions will  
have an adverse effect on paint, metal trim, and under-  
body protection.  
Salt in the air near sea coast localities.  
Atmospheric fallout/ industrial pollutants.  
Washing  
Wash your vehicle regularly. Always wash your ve-  
hicle in the shade using a mild car wash soap, and  
rinse the panels completely with clear water.  
The following maintenance recommendations will enable  
you to obtain maximum benefit from the corrosion  
resistance built into your vehicle.  
If insects, tar or other similar deposits have accumu-  
lated on your vehicle, wash it as soon as possible.  
What Causes Corrosion?  
Corrosion is the result of deterioration or removal of  
paint and protective coatings from your vehicle.  
Use Mopar auto polish to remove road film and stains  
and to polish your vehicle. Take care never to scratch  
the paint.  
The most common causes are:  
7
Road salt, dirt and moisture accumulation.  
Stone and gravel impact.  
Avoid using abrasive compounds and power buffing  
that may diminish the gloss or thin out the paint  
finish.  
Insects, tree sap and tar.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
278 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
Use Mopar touch up paint on scratches or chips as  
soon as possible. Your dealer has touch up paint to  
match the color of your vehicle.  
CAUTION!  
Do not use abrasive or strong cleaning materials  
such as steel wool or scouring powder, which will  
scratch metal and painted surfaces.  
If your vehicle is damaged due to an accident or  
similar cause which destroys the paint and protective  
coating have your vehicle repaired as soon as possible.  
The cost of such repairs is considered the responsibil-  
ity of the owner.  
Special Care  
If you drive on salted or dusty roads or if you drive  
near the ocean, hose off the undercarriage at least once  
a month.  
If you carry special cargo such as chemicals, fertilizers,  
deicer salt, etc., be sure that such materials are well  
packaged and sealed.  
It is important that the drain holes in the lower edges  
of the doors, rocker panels and rear deck lid be kept  
clear and open.  
If a lot of driving is done on gravel roads, consider  
mud or stone shields behind each wheel.  
If you detect any stone chips or scratches in the paint,  
touch them up immediately. The cost of such repairs is  
considered the responsibility of the owner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 279  
When cleaning extremely dirty wheels, care must be  
taken in the selection of tire and wheel cleaning chemi-  
cals and equipment to prevent damage to the wheels.  
Only Mopar Wheel Cleaners are recommended. DO NOT  
USE any of the items listed below which can damage  
your wheels and wheel trim.  
CAUTION!  
If your vehicle is equipped with flame or woodgrain  
graphics, it is recommended that special care be  
taken when using hand-held pressure washers to  
clean your vehicle. The pressure of these hand-held  
car wash wands can vary greatly and could possibly  
cause damage to the surface of the graphic. Hold the  
tip of the wand at least 12 inches away from the  
graphic surface when cleaning the vehicle.  
DO NOT USE:  
Any abrasive cleaner  
Any abrasive cleaning pad (such as steel wool) or  
abrasive brush  
Wheel And Wheel Trim Care  
Any cleaner that contains an acid which can react with  
and discolor the chrome surface.  
7
All wheels and wheel trim, especially Aluminum and  
Chrome plated, should be cleaned regularly, when cool,  
using mild soap and water to maintain their luster and to  
prevent corrosion. Wash them with the same soap solu-  
tion as the body of your vehicle. Rinse wheels thor-  
oughly.  
Chrome polish  
Oven cleaner  
A car wash that uses carbide-tipped wheel cleaning  
brushes or acidic solutions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
280 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
Your leather upholstery can be best preserved by regular  
cleaning with a damp soft cloth. Small particles of dirt  
can act as an abrasive and damage the leather upholstery  
and should be removed promptly with a damp cloth.  
Stubborn soils can be removed easily with a soft cloth  
and Mopar Total Clean. Care should be taken to avoid  
soaking your leather upholstery with any liquid. Please  
do not use polishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, deter-  
gents, or ammonia based cleaners to clean your leather  
upholstery. Application of a leather conditioner is not  
required to maintain the original condition.  
CAUTION!  
Many wheel cleaners contain acids that may harm  
the wheel surface.  
NOTE: Replacement costs for components damaged as  
a result of not following the recommended cleaning  
practices are considered the responsibility of the cus-  
tomer.  
Interior Care  
Use Mopar Fabric Cleaner to clean fabric upholstery and  
carpeting.  
WARNING!  
Use Mopar Vinyl Cleaner to clean vinyl upholstery and  
vinyl trim.  
Do not use volatile solvents for cleaning purposes.  
Many are potentially flammable, and if used in  
closed areas they may cause respiratory harm.  
Mopar Total Clean is specifically recommended for  
leather upholstery.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 281  
Cleaning Headlights  
Your vehicle has plastic headlights that are lighter and  
less susceptible to stone breakage than glass headlights.  
cleaning inside rear windows equipped with electric  
defrosters. Do not use scrapers or other sharp instru-  
ments which may scratch the elements.  
Plastic is not as scratch resistant as glass and therefore  
different lens cleaning procedures must be followed.  
Instrument Panel Cover  
The instrument panel cover has a low glare surface which  
minimizes reflections in the windshield. Do not use  
protectants or other products which may cause undesir-  
able reflections. Use soap and warm water to restore the  
low glare surface.  
To minimize the possibility of scratching the lenses and  
reducing light output, avoid wiping with a dry cloth. To  
remove road dirt, wash with a mild soap solution fol-  
lowed by rinsing.  
Cleaning Plastic Instrument Cluster Lenses  
The lenses in front of the instruments in the vehicle are  
molded in clear plastic. When cleaning the lenses, care  
must be taken to avoid scratching the plastic.  
Do not use abrasive cleaning components, solvents, steel  
wool or other aggressive material to clean the lenses.  
7
Glass Surfaces  
All glass surfaces should be cleaned on a regular basis  
with any commercial household-type glass cleaner.  
Never use an abrasive type cleaner. Use caution when  
1. Clean with a wet soft rag. A mild soap solution may be  
used, but do not use high alcohol content of abrasive  
cleaners. If soap is used, wipe clean with a clean damp  
rag.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
282 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
2. Dry with a soft tissue.  
FUSES  
Seat Belt Maintenance  
Underhood Fuses (Power Distribution Center)  
A Power Distribution Center is located in the engine  
compartment; next to the air cleaner filter. A label iden-  
tifying the components and circuits is located on the  
underside of the cover.  
Do not bleach, dye or clean the belts with chemical  
solvents or abrasive cleaners. This will weaken the fabric.  
Sun damage will also weaken the fabric.  
If the belts need cleaning, use a mild soap solution or  
lukewarm water. Do not remove the belts from the  
vehicle to wash them.  
Replace the belts if they appear frayed or worn or if the  
buckles do not work properly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 283  
7
Power Distribution Center Cover  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
284 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
FUSE  
Amp/Color  
Items Fused  
Ignition Start  
FUSE  
13  
Amp/Color  
Items Fused  
1
2
30 Amp/ Pink  
20 Amp/  
Yellow  
Fuel Pump/ Auto Shut  
Down (ASD)  
40 Amp/ Green Anti-Lock Brake (ABS)  
Pump  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
15 Amp/ Lt.  
Blue  
Horn  
3
4
5
6
7
40 Amp/ Green Ignition Run  
20 Amp/  
Yellow  
Electronic Automatic  
Transaxle (ETAX)  
30 Amp/ Blue  
Heated Seats  
40 Amp/ Green Radiator Fan  
15 Amp/ Lt.  
Blue  
Hi Beam  
20 Amp/ Blue  
30 Amp/ Blue  
Power Height Adjuster  
Anti-Lock Brake (ABS) So-  
lenoid  
20 Amp/  
Yellow  
Ignition Off Draw (IOD)  
Hazard  
8
9
40 Amp/ Green Electric Back Light (EBL)  
Spare  
15 Amp/ Lt.  
Blue  
20 Amp/  
Yellow  
Power Outlets  
10  
40 Amp/ Green Exterior Lighting, Remote  
Keyless Entry, Alarm and  
Door Locks  
20  
21  
Spare  
11  
12  
10 Amp/ Red  
Air Conditioning (A/ C)  
Stop Lights  
20 Amp/  
Yellow  
Fog Lights (Build-Up Ex-  
port Only)  
15 Amp/ Lt.  
Blue  
22  
Spare  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 285  
Interior Fuses  
CAUTION!  
The fuse access panel is on the left side of the instrument  
panel next to the steering column. To remove the panel,  
pull it out, as shown. A label identifying the components  
and circuits is located on the inside of the cover.  
When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to use  
only a fuse having the correct amperage rating. The  
use of a fuse with a rating other than indicated may  
result in a dangerous electrical system overload. If a  
properly rated fuse continues to blow, it shows a  
problem in the circuit that must be corrected.  
VEHICLE STORAGE  
If you will not be using your vehicle for more than 21  
days you may want to take steps to preserve your battery.  
You may:  
7
Disengage the mini fuse in the Power Distribution  
Center labeled IOD (Ignition Off-Draw).  
Or, disconnect the negative cable from the battery.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
286 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
REPLACEMENT BULBS  
LIGHT BULBS — Inside  
Bulb No.  
Overhead Reading Light (Rearview Mirror) . . . . . T192  
Rear Cargo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . T906  
Seat Belt Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
Security Alarm Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
Malfunction Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
Temperature Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
Trac (Active) Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VFD *  
TRAC OFF Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
Trip Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VFD *  
Turn Signal Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103  
Visor Vanity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6501966  
Voltage Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
LIGHT BULBS — Inside  
Bulb No.  
ABS Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
Airbag Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
Brake System Warning Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
Center Console Floor Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . T37  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6233137  
Console Gear Selector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PC194  
Cruise Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VFD *  
Dome Light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . T579  
Door Ajar Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VFD *  
Front Fog Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
High Beam Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74  
Instrument Cluster Illumination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74  
Liftgate Ajar Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
Low Fuel Indicator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
Low Oil Pressure Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED  
Overhead Reading Light (Overhead Console) . . . T1037  
NOTE: * Vacuum Fluorescent Display  
All the inside bulbs are brass or glass wedge base.  
Aluminum base bulbs are not approved and should not  
be used for replacement.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 287  
1. Remove the headlight access cover splash shield,  
located in the front wheel well opening.  
LIGHTS BULBS — Outside  
Bulb No.  
Low Beam Headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9006XS  
High Beam Headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9005XS  
Front Park/ Turn Signal/ Side Marker Light . 4157NAKX  
Front Fog Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9006  
Center High Mounted Stop Light  
2. Disconnect the electrical connector.  
(CHMSL). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 921–W16W  
Rear Tail/ Stop/ Turn Signal Light . . . . . . 3157–P27/7W  
Backup Light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3157-P27/7W  
License Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168  
BULB REPLACEMENT  
Headlight Bulb Replacement  
7
CAUTION!  
3. Rotate the socket to the left one quarter turn and  
replace the bulb.  
Do not touch the new headlight bulb with your  
fingers. Oil contamination will severely shorten  
bulb life.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
288 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
Front Park/Turn Signal/Side Marker Lights  
Front Fog Lights — If Equipped  
1. Remove the headlight access cover splash shield,  
located in the front wheel well opening.  
1. Remove the fasteners attaching the lower splash  
shield to gain access to the fog light.  
2. Rotate the socket to the left one quarter turn to replace  
and replace the bulb.  
2. Twist and remove the bulb from the fog light housing.  
3. Disconnect the electrical connector and replace bulb.  
Tail/Stop, and Rear Turn Signal Lights  
1. Remove the screw attaching the tail light housing and  
remove the housing from the vehicle.  
2. Twist the bulb socket 1/ 4 turn to remove it from the  
housing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 289  
Back Up Light Bulb  
1. Remove the screws attaching the back up light to the  
rear fascia and remove the housing.  
2. Remove the socket from the housing.  
3. Pull the bulb out of the socket and replace.  
Center High Mounted Stop Light  
1. Open the liftgate and remove the liftgate CHMSL  
cover.  
2. Remove CHMSL lens from the housing by unlatching  
the two side latches.  
7
3. Pull the bulb out of the socket and replace.  
3. Pull the bulb out of the socket and replace.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
290 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
FLUIDS AND CAPACITIES  
U.S.  
Metric  
Fuel (Approximate)  
15 Gallons  
56.7 Liters  
Engine Oil-With Filter  
2.4 Liter Engines (SAE 5W-30, API Certified Engine Oil)  
Cooling System *  
5.0 qts  
4.8 Liters  
2.4 Liter Turbocharged Engines (MoparAntifreeze/ Coolant 5  
8.1 qts  
6.5 qts  
7.7 Liters  
6.2 Liters  
Year/ 100,000 Miles Formula)  
2.4 Liter Non-Turbocharged Engines (MoparAntifreeze/  
Coolant 5 Year/ 100,000 Miles Formula)  
* Includes heater and coolant recovery bottle filled to MAX level.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 291  
RECOMMENDED FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS AND GENUINE PARTS  
Engine  
Component  
Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts  
Engine Coolant  
MoparAntifreeze/ Coolant 5 Year/ 100,000 Mile Formula HOAT (Hybrid Or-  
ganic Additive Technology)  
Engine Oil  
Use API Certified SAE 5W-30 Engine Oil. Refer to oil viscosity chart for cor-  
rect SAE grade meeting DaimlerChrysler Material Standard MS-6395.  
Engine Oil Filter  
Spark Plugs  
Non Turbo—Mopar 4105409 or equiv. Turbo—Mopar 4781452AA or equiv.  
Refer to the Vehicle Emission Control Information label in the engine com-  
partment.  
Fuel Selection  
91 Octane for High Output 2.4L Turbo and 87 Octane for 2.4L Standard  
Turbo and 2.4L Standard Non Turbo Engines.  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
292 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE  
Chassis  
Component  
Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts.  
Automatic Transmission Fluid.  
Manual Transmission Fluid.  
Brake Master Cylinder  
MoparATF+4 Automatic Transmission Fluid.  
MoparATF+4 Automatic Transmission Fluid.  
MoparDOT 3 and SAE J1703 should be used. If DOT 3 brake fluid is not  
available, then DOT 4 is acceptable. Use only recommended brake fluids.  
Power Steering Reservoir  
MoparATF+4 Automatic Transmission Fluid.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES  
CONTENTS  
Emission Control System Maintenance . . . . . . . . 294  
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294  
Schedule “B—All Engines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297  
Schedule “A”—2.4L Non Turbo Charged  
Engines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305  
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Schedule “A”—2.4L Turbocharged Engines . . . 309  
E
S
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
294 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES  
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM MAINTENANCE  
The “Scheduled” maintenance services, listed in bold  
type must be done at the times or mileages specified to  
assure the continued proper functioning of the emission  
control system. These, and all other maintenance services  
included in this manual, should be done to provide best  
vehicle performance and reliability. More frequent main-  
tenance may be needed for vehicles in severe operating  
conditions such as dusty areas and very short trip  
driving.  
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE  
There are three maintenance schedules that show re-  
quired service for your vehicle.  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
First is Schedule “B”—ALL ENGINES. It is for vehicles  
that are operated under the conditions that are listed  
below and at the beginning of the schedule.  
Day and night temperatures are below 32° F (0° C).  
Stop and go driving.  
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Extensive engine idling.  
Inspection and service also should be done any time a  
malfunction is suspected.  
Driving in dusty conditions.  
Short trips of less than 10 miles (16 km).  
E
S
NOTE: Maintenance, replacement, or repair of the emis-  
sion control devices and systems on your vehicle may be  
performed by any automotive repair establishment or  
individual using any automotive part which has been  
certified pursuant to U.S. EPA or, in the State of Califor-  
nia, California Air Resources Board regulations.  
More than 50% of your driving is at sustained high  
speeds during hot weather, above 90° F (32° C).  
8
Trailer towing.†छ  
Taxi, police, or delivery service (commercial ser-  
vice).†छ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 295  
Off-road or desert operation.  
Use the schedule that best describes your driving condi-  
tions. Where time and mileage are listed, follow the  
interval that occurs first.  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
If equipped for and operating with E-85 (ethanol)  
fuel.  
NOTE: If ANY of these apply to you then change your  
engine oil every 3,000 miles (5 000 km) or 3 months,  
whichever comes first and follow schedule “B—All En-  
gines” of the ЉMaintenance SchedulesЉ section of this  
manual.  
CAUTION!  
Failure to perform the required maintenance items  
may result in damage to the vehicle.  
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
NOTE: Most vehicles are operated under the conditions  
listed for Schedule ЉBЉ—ALL ENGINES.  
At Each Stop for Fuel  
Check the engine oil level about 5 minutes after a fully  
warmed engine is shut off. Checking the oil level while  
the vehicle is on level ground will improve the accu-  
racy of the oil level reading. Add oil only when the  
level is at or below the ADD or MIN mark.  
Second is Schedule “A”—NON TURBO CHARGED  
ENGINES. It is for vehicles that are not operated under  
any of the conditions listed under Schedule ЉBЉ—ALL  
ENGINES.  
E
S
8
Third is Schedule “A”—TURBO CHARGED ENGINES.  
It is for vehicles that are not operated under any of the  
conditions listed under Schedule ЉBЉ—ALL ENGINES.  
Check the windshield washer solvent and add if  
required.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
296 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES  
Once a Month  
Inspect the brake hoses.  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
Check tire pressure and look for unusual wear or  
damage.  
Inspect the CV joints and front suspension compo-  
nents.  
Inspect the battery and clean and tighten the terminals  
as required.  
Check the automatic transaxle fluid level.  
Check the manual transaxle fluid level and fill plug  
condition.  
Check the fluid levels of coolant reservoir, brake  
master cylinder and transaxle and add as needed.  
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Check the coolant level, hoses, and clamps.  
Check all lights and all other electrical items for correct  
operation.  
Rotate the tires at each oil change interval shown on  
Schedule “A”—NON TURBO CHARGED ENGINES  
6,000 miles (10 000 km), Schedule “A”—TURBO  
CHARGED ENGINES 5,000 miles (8 000 km), or every  
other interval shown on Schedule “B—ALL EN-  
GINES 6,000 miles (10 000 km).  
Check rubber seals on each side of the radiator for  
proper fit.  
E
S
At Each Oil Change  
8
Change the engine oil filter.  
Inspect the exhaust system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 297  
SCHEDULE “B”—ALL ENGINES  
Follow schedule “B—All Engines if you usually operate  
your vehicle under one or more of the following condi-  
tions.  
Short trips of less than 10 miles (16.2 km).  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
More than 50% of your driving is at sustained high  
speeds during hot weather, above 90° F (32° C ).  
Trailer towing.†छ  
Change the automatic transmission fluid and filter every  
60,000 miles (96 000 km) if the vehicle is usually operated  
under one or more of the conditions marked with an .  
Taxi, police, or delivery service (commercial ser-  
vice).†छ  
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Change the manual transaxle fluid every 48,000 miles (77  
000 km) if the vehicle is usually operated under one or  
more of the conditions marked with an †.  
Off-road or desert operation.  
If equipped for and operating with E-85 (ethanol)  
fuel.  
Day and night temperatures are below32° F (0° C).  
Stop and go driving.  
NOTE: If ANY of these apply to you then change your  
engine oil every 3,000 miles (5 000 km) or 3 months,  
whichever comes first and follow schedule “B—All En-  
gines” of the ЉMaintenance SchedulesЉ section of this  
manual.  
E
S
8
Extensive engine idling.  
Driving in dusty conditions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
298 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES  
If none of these apply to you, and your vehicle is  
equipped with a Non–Turbo Charged Engine then  
change your engine oil at every interval shown on  
schedule “A”—NON TURBO CHARGED ENGINES in  
the maintenance schedule section of this manual.  
If none of these apply to you, and your vehicle is  
equipped with a Turbo Charged Engine change your  
engine oil at every interval shown on schedule  
“A”—TURBO CHARGED ENGINES in the maintenance  
schedule section of this manual.  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
Miles  
3,000  
(5 000)  
X
6,000  
9,000  
12,000  
15,000  
18,000  
(29 000)  
X
(Kilometers)  
(10 000) (14 000) (19 000) (24 000)  
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
X
X
X
X
X
Inspect the engine air cleaner filter. Replace  
as necessary.*  
X
X
Inspect the PCV make-up air filter. Replace as  
necessary.  
E
S
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 299  
Miles  
21,000  
24,000  
27,000  
30,000  
33,000  
36,000  
(58 000)  
X
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
(Kilometers)  
(34 000) (38 000) (43 000) (48 000) (53 000)  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
Replace the engine air cleaner filter.  
Replace the spark plugs.  
Inspect the tie rod ends and boot seals.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Inspect the PCV valve and replace as neces-  
sary.*  
Replace the PCV make-up air filter.  
X
X
Adjust the generator drive belt tension.  
E
S
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
300 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES  
Miles  
39,000  
42,000  
45,000  
48,000  
51,000  
54,000  
(86 000)  
X
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
( Kilometers)  
(62 000) (67 000) (72 000) (77 000) (82 000)  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Change the brake fluid. If vehicle is used for  
trailer towing.  
Inspect the engine air cleaner filter. Replace  
as necessary.*  
X
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Change the manual transaxle fluid.†  
X
Inspect the PCV make-up air filter. Replace as  
necessary.  
E
S
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 301  
Miles  
57,000  
60,000  
63,000  
66,000  
69,000  
72,000  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
( Kilometers)  
(91 000) (96 000) (101 000) (106 000) (111 000) (115 000)  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Replace the engine air cleaner filter.  
Replace the spark plugs and ignition cables.  
Inspect the tie rod ends and boot seals.  
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Inspect the PCV valve and replace if neces-  
sary. Not required if previously changed. * ‡  
Inspect the PCV make-up air filter. Replace as  
necessary.  
X
Adjust the generator drive belt tension.  
X
X
E
S
Change the automatic transaxle fluid and fil-  
ter.  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
302 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES  
Miles  
75,000  
78,000  
81,000  
84,000  
87,000  
90,000  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
(Kilometers)  
(120 000) (125 000) (130 000) (135 000) (130 000) (144 000)  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Inspect the engine air cleaner filter and re-  
place as necessary.*  
Replace the engine air cleaner filter.  
Replace the spark plugs.  
X
X
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Inspect the tie rod ends and boot seals.  
Inspect the PCV valve and replace if neces-  
sary. Not required if previously changed. * ‡  
X
Replace the engine timing belt. *  
X
X
E
S
Inspect the PCV make-up air filter. Replace as  
necessary.  
X
8
Adjust the generator drive belt tension.  
X
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 303  
Miles  
93,000  
(150 000)  
X
96,000  
99,000  
(159 000)  
X
102,000  
(164 000)  
X
105,000  
(168 000)  
X
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
(Kilometers)  
(154 000)  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
X
X
X
Change the brake fluid. If vehicle is used for trailer  
towing.  
Inspect the engine air cleaner filter and replace as  
necessary.*  
X
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Change the manual transaxle fluid.†  
X
Flush and replace the engine coolant at 60 months  
or 102,000 miles.  
X
Inspect the PCV make-up air filter. Replace as nec-  
essary.  
E
S
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
304 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES  
Miles  
108,000  
(173 000)  
X
111,000  
(178 000)  
X
114,000  
117,000  
(188 000)  
X
120,000  
(193 000)  
X
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
(Kilometers)  
(183 000)  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
X
X
Inspect the engine air cleaner filter and replace as  
necessary.*  
X
Inspect the tie rod ends and boot seals.  
X
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Inspect the PCV make-up air filter. Replace as nec-  
essary.  
X
Adjust the generator drive belt tension.  
X
X
Change automatic transaxle fluid and filter.छ  
E
S
* This maintenance is recommended by the manufacturer  
to the owner but is not required to maintain the emis-  
sions warranty.  
This maintenance is required only for police, taxi,  
limousine type operation, or trailer towing.  
8
Inspection and service should also be performed anytime  
a malfunction is observed or suspected. Retain all re-  
ceipts.  
‡ This maintenance is not required if previously replaced.  
† This maintenance is required only for police, taxi,  
limousine type operation, or trailer towing.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 305  
SCHEDULE “A”—2.4L NON TURBO CHARGED ENGINES  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
Miles  
6,000  
(10 000)  
[6]  
12,000  
18,000  
24,000  
30,000  
36,000  
(Kilometers )  
(19 000) (29 000) (38 000) (48 000) (58 000)  
[Months]  
[12]  
[18]  
X
[24]  
[30]  
[36]  
X
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
Replace the engine air cleaner filter.  
Replace the spark plugs.  
Inspect the tie rod ends and boot seals.  
Replace the PCV make-up air filter.  
Adjust the generator drive belt tension  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
306 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES  
Miles  
42,000  
(67 000)  
[42]  
48,000  
(77 000)  
[48]  
54,000  
(86 000)  
[54]  
60,000  
(96 000)  
[60]  
66,000  
(106 000)  
[66]  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
(Kilometers)  
[Months]  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
Replace the engine air cleaner filter.  
Replace the spark plugs and ignition cables.  
Inspect the tie rod ends and boot seals.  
Inspect the PCV valve and replace, if necessary.*  
X
X
X
X
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Flush and replace the engine coolant at 60 months,  
regardless of mileage.  
Replace the PCV make-up air filter.  
X
X
E
S
Adjust the generator drive belt tension.  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 307  
Miles  
72,000  
78,000  
84,000  
90,000  
96,000  
102,000  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
(Kilometers)  
(115 000  
(125  
000)  
(134  
000)  
(144  
000)  
(154 000)  
(163  
000)  
[Months]  
[72]  
X
[78]  
[84]  
[90]  
X
[96]  
[102]  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
Replace the engine air cleaner filter.  
Replace the spark plugs.  
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
X
Inspect the tie rod ends and boot seals.  
X
Inspect the PCV valve and replace if necessary. Not  
required if previously changed. * ‡  
X
Replace the PCV make-up air filter.  
X
X
E
S
Adjust the generator drive belt tension.  
8
Flush and replace the engine coolant at 60 months  
or 102,000 miles.  
X
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
308 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES  
Miles  
108,000  
(173 000)  
[108]  
114,000  
(182 000)  
[114]  
120,000  
(192 000)  
[120]  
X
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
(Kilometers)  
[Months]  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the PCV valve and replace if necessary. *  
X
X
X
* This maintenance is recommended by the manufacturer  
to the owner but is not required to maintain the emis-  
sions warranty.  
Inspection and service should also be performed anytime  
a malfunction is observed or suspected. Retain all re-  
ceipts.  
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
‡ This maintenance is not required if previously replaced.  
E
S
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 309  
SCHEDULE “A”—2.4L TURBOCHARGED ENGINES  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
Miles  
5,000  
(8 000)  
[6]  
10,000  
15,000  
20,000  
25,000  
30,000  
(Kilometers)  
(16 000) (24 000) (32 000) (40 000) (48 000)  
[Months]  
[12]  
[18]  
X
[24]  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
Replace the engine air cleaner filter.  
Replace the spark plugs.  
Inspect the tie rod ends and boot seals.  
Replace the PCV make-up air filter.  
Adjust the generator drive belt tension.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
310 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES  
Miles  
35,000  
(56 000)  
[30]  
40,000  
45,000  
(72 000)  
[36]  
50,000  
(80 000)  
[42]  
55,000  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
(Kilometers)  
(64 000)  
(88 000)  
[Months]  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
E
S
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 311  
Miles  
60,000  
65,000  
70,000  
75,000  
80,000  
85,000  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
(Kilometers)  
(96 000)  
(104  
000)  
(112  
000)  
(120  
000)  
(128  
000)  
(136 000)  
[Months]  
[48]  
X
[54]  
[60]  
[66]  
X
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
Replace the engine air cleaner filter.  
Replace the spark plugs and ignition cables.  
Inspect the tie rod ends and boot seals.  
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
X
X
Inspect the PCV valve and replace if necessary. Not  
required if previously changed. * ‡  
X
Flush and replace the engine coolant at 60 months,  
regardless of mileage.  
E
S
X
Replace the PCV make-up air filter.  
X
X
8
Adjust the generator drive belt tension.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
312 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES  
Miles  
90,000  
(144 000)  
[72]  
95,000  
100,000  
105,000  
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
(Kilometers)  
(156 000) (160 000) (168 000)  
[Months]  
[78]  
[84]  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the brake linings.  
Replace the engine air cleaner filter.  
Replace the spark plugs.  
Adjust the generator drive belt tension.  
Inspect the tie rod ends and boot seals.  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
Inspect the PCV valve and replace if necessary. Not required if  
previously changed. * ‡  
X
E
S
Flush and replace the engine coolant if not done at 60 months.  
Replace the PCV make-up air filter.  
X
X
8
Replace the engine timing belt.  
X
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M
A
I
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 313  
Miles  
110,000  
(177 000)  
[90]  
115,000  
(185 000)  
[96]  
120,000  
(193 000)  
[102]  
X
N
T
E
N
A
N
C
E
(Kilometers)  
[Month]  
Change engine oil and engine oil filter.  
Inspect the PCV Valve and replace if necessary. *  
X
X
X
* This maintenance is recommended by the manufacturer  
to the owner but is not required to maintain the emis-  
sions warranty.  
WARNING!  
S
C
H
E
D
U
L
You can be badly injured working on or around a  
motor vehicle. Do only that service work for which  
you have the knowledge and the right equipment. If  
you have any doubt about your ability to perform a  
service job, take your vehicle to a competent me-  
chanic.  
‡ This maintenance is not required if previously replaced.  
Inspection and service should also be performed anytime  
a malfunction is observed or suspected. Retain all re-  
ceipts.  
E
S
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE  
CONTENTS  
Suggestions For Obtaining Service For Your  
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321  
In Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321  
Publication Order Forms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316  
Prepare For The Appointment . . . . . . . . . . . . 316  
Prepare A List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316  
Be Reasonable With Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316  
If You Need Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316  
Warranty Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319  
MoparParts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321  
Department Of Transportation Uniform Tire  
Quality Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323  
Treadwear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323  
Traction Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323  
Temperature Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
316 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE  
SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR  
YOUR VEHICLE  
Be Reasonable With Requests  
If you list a number of items, and you must have your  
vehicle by the end of the day, discuss the situation with  
the service advisor and list the items in order of priority.  
At many dealers you may obtain a rental vehicle at a  
minimal daily charge. If you need a rental, it is advisable  
to make these arrangements when you call for an ap-  
pointment.  
Prepare For The Appointment  
If youre having warranty work done, be sure to have the  
right papers with you. Take your warranty folder. All  
work to be performed may not be covered by the  
warranty, discuss additional charges with the service  
manager. Keep a maintenance log of your vehicles  
service history. This can often provide a clue to the  
current problem.  
IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE  
The manufacturer and its dealers are vitally interested in  
your satisfaction. We want you to be happy with our  
products and services.  
Prepare A List  
Make a written list of your vehicles problems or the  
specific work you want done. If youve had an accident,  
or work done that is not on your maintenance log, let the  
service advisor know.  
Your selling dealer is best equipped and most anxious to  
provide prompt resolution for any warranty issue or  
related matter that you may experience. The manufactur-  
ers dealers have the facilities, factory-trained techni-  
cians, special tools, and the latest information to assure  
your vehicle is fixed correctly and in a timely manner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 317  
The manufacturer has empowered its dealers to make  
warranty and repair decisions that ensure you are not  
inconvenienced. There is no need for you to wait for a  
decision from the manufacturer. If a special circumstance  
occurs that requires information from the manufacturer,  
we have asked the dealers service management to make  
the contact on your behalf.  
Owners name and address  
Owners telephone number (home and office)  
Dealership name  
Vehicle identification number  
Vehicle delivery date and mileage  
This is why you should always talk to your dealers  
service manager first. Most matters can be resolved with  
this process.  
DaimlerChrysler Motors Corporation Customer Center  
P.O. Box 21–8004  
Auburn Hills, MI 48321–8004  
Phone: (800) 992-1997  
If for some reason you are still not satisfied, talk to the  
general manager or owner of the dealership. They  
want to know if you need assistance.  
DaimlerChrysler Canada Inc. Customer Center  
P.O. Box 1621  
Windsor, Ontario N9A 4H6  
Phone —(800) 465–2001  
If your dealership is unable to resolve the concern, you  
may contact the Manufacturers Customer Center.  
9
Any communication to the Manufacturers Customer  
Center should include the following information:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
318 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE  
In Mexico contact:  
Service Contract  
Av. Prolongacion Paseo de la Reforma, 1240  
Sante Fe C.P. 05109  
Mexico, D. F.  
In Mexico (915) 729–1248 or 729–1240  
Outside Mexico (525) 729–1248 or 729–1240  
You may have purchased a service contract for your  
vehicle to help protect you from the high cost of unex-  
pected repairs after your manufacturers new vehicle  
limited warranty expires. The manufacturer stands be-  
hind only the manufacturers Service Contracts. If you  
purchased a manufacturers Service Contract, you will  
receive Plan Provisions and an Owner Identification Card  
in the mail within three weeks of your vehicle delivery  
date. If you have any questions about your service  
contract, call the manufacturers Service Contract Na-  
tional Customer Hotline at 1-800-521-9922.  
Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech  
Impaired (TDD/TTY)  
To assist customers who have hearing difficulties, the  
manufacturer has installed special TDD (Telecommuni-  
cation Devices for the Deaf) equipment at its Customer  
Center. Any hearing or speech impaired customer who  
has access to a TDD or a conventional teletypewriter  
(TTY) in the United States can communicate with the  
manufacturer by dialing 1–800–380–CHRY.  
The manufacturer will not stand behind any service  
contract that is not the manufacturers Service Contract. It  
is not responsible for any service contract other than the  
manufacturers Service Contract. If you purchased a  
service contract that is not a manufacturers Service  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 319  
Contract, and you require service after your manufactur-  
ers new vehicle limited warranty expires, please refer to  
your contract documents, and contact the person listed in  
those documents.  
sincere efforts to resolve any warranty issues or related  
concerns.  
WARRANTY INFORMATION  
See your manufacturers Warranty Information Booklet  
for information on warranty coverage and transfer of  
warranty.  
We appreciate that you have made a major investment  
when you purchased your new vehicle. Your dealer has  
also made a major investment in facilities, tools, and  
training to assure that you are absolutely delighted with  
your ownership experience. Youll be pleased with their  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
320 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 321  
MOPARPARTS  
To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety  
Hotline toll free at 1-800-424-9393 (or 366-0123 in Wash-  
ington DC area) or write to: NHTSA, U.S. Dept. of  
Transportation, Washington DC 20590. You can also  
obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from  
the Hotline.  
Moparfluids, lubricants, parts, and accessories are  
available from your dealer. They will help you keep your  
vehicle operating at its best.  
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS  
In the 50 United States and Washington D.C.: If you  
believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause  
a crash or cause injury or death, you should immediately  
inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administra-  
tion (NHTSA) in addition to notifying the manufacturer.  
In Canada:  
If you believe that your vehicle has a safety defect, you  
should contact the Customer Service Department imme-  
diately. Canadian customers who wish to report a safety  
defect to the Canadian government should write to  
Transport Canada, Motor Vehicle Defect Investigations  
and Recalls, 2780 Sheffield Road, Ottawa, Ontario K1B  
3V9.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an  
investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in  
a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy  
campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in  
individual problems between you, your dealer, and the  
manufacturer.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
322 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE  
PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS  
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals.  
To order the following manuals, you may use either the  
website or the phone numbers listed below. Visa, Mas-  
tercard, American Express, and Discover orders are ac-  
cepted. If you prefer mailing your payment, please call  
for an order form.  
Filled with diagrams, charts and detailed illustrations,  
these practical manuals make it easy for students and  
technicians to find and fix problems on computer-  
controlled vehicle systems and features. They show  
exactly how to find and correct problems the first time,  
using step-by-step troubleshooting and driveability  
procedures, proven diagnostic tests and a complete list  
of all tools and equipment.  
NOTE: A street address is required when ordering  
manuals. (No P.O. Boxes).  
Service Manuals.  
Owner’s Manuals.  
These comprehensive service manuals provide the  
information that students and professional technicians  
need in diagnosing/ troubleshooting, problem solving,  
maintaining, servicing and repairing DaimlerChrysler  
Corporation vehicles. A complete working knowledge  
of the vehicle, system and/ or components is written in  
straightforward language with illustrations, diagrams  
and charts.  
These manuals have been prepared with the assistance  
of service and engineering specialists to acquaint you  
with specific Chrysler group vehicles. Included are  
starting, operating, emergency and maintenance pro-  
cedures as well as specifications, capabilities and  
safety tips.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 323  
Call Toll Free at 1–800–890–4038 (U.S.) or 1–800–387–1143  
Treadwear  
(Canada)  
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the  
wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled con-  
ditions on a specified government test course. For ex-  
ample, a tire graded 150 would wear one and a half (1  
1/ 2) times as well on the government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends  
upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and  
may depart significantly from the norm due to variations  
in driving habits, service practices and differences in road  
characteristics and climate.  
Or  
Visit us on the World Wide Web at:  
www.techauthority.daimlerchrysler.com or  
www.daimlerchrysler.ca/manuals  
DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM  
TIRE QUALITY GRADES  
The following describes the tire grading categories estab-  
lished by the National highway Traffic Safety Adminis-  
tration. The specific grade rating assigned by the tires  
manufacturer in each category is shown on the sidewall  
of the tires on your car.  
Traction Grades  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are A, B, and  
C, and they represent the tires ability to stop on wet  
pavement as measured under controlled conditions on  
specified government test surfaces of asphalt and con-  
crete. A tire marked C may have poor traction perfor-  
mance.  
All Passenger Car Tires Must Conform to Federal Safety  
Requirements in Addition to These Grades.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
324 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE  
WARNING!  
WARNING!  
The traction grade is based on braking (straight-  
ahead) traction tests and does not include cornering  
(turning) performance.  
The temperature grade is established for a tire that is  
properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive  
speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either  
separately or in combination, can cause heat buildup  
and possible tire failure.  
Temperature Grades  
The temperature grades are A (highest), B, and C, repre-  
senting the tires resistance to the generation of heat and  
its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled  
conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel.  
Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the  
tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive  
temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C  
corresponds to a level of performance which all passen-  
ger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent  
higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel  
than the minimum required by law.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
326 INDEX  
ABS (Anti-Lock Brake) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194  
Adding Engine Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . 267  
Adding Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221  
Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175  
Additives, Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219  
Air Cleaner, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258  
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261  
Air Conditioning Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166  
Air Conditioning, Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . 171  
Air Conditioning Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261  
Air Conditioning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166,261  
Air Pressure, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207  
Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41  
Airbag Deployment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48  
Airbag Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45,50,60,134  
Airbag Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
Airbag, Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47  
Alarm, Panic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
Alarm System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26,129  
Alignment and Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213  
Alterations/ Modifications, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7  
Antenna, Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164  
Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . . . . 267,290,291  
Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290  
Anti-Lock Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194  
Anti-Lock Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131  
Anti-Theft Security Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276  
Auto Down Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31  
Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12,180,183,273  
Fluid and Filter Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275  
Fluid Level Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273,274  
Interlock System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18,184  
Reset Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184  
Selection Of Lubricant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273  
Shifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185  
Special Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX 327  
Autostick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135,187  
Brake/ Transmission Interlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184  
Break-In Recommendations, New Vehicle . . . . . . . . 59  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286,287  
Bulbs, Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286  
Back-Up Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289  
Ball Joints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259  
Keyless Transmitter Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
Belts, Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
Belts, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258  
Body Mechanism Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262  
B-Pillar Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202  
Brake Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292  
Brake, Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192  
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194,270  
Anti-Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194  
Hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270  
Master Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271  
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192  
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194,270  
Calibration, Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107  
Capacities, Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . 290  
Capacities, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290  
Caps, Filler  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221  
Radiator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267  
Carbon Monoxide Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220  
Cargo Compartment  
Luggage Carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119  
Carrier, Luggage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119  
Cassette Tape and Player Maintenance . . . . . . . . . 165  
Cassette Tape Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138  
Catalytic Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
Caution, Exhaust Gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
328 INDEX  
CD Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146,152  
CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144,148,150,154,157  
CD Player Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166  
Cellular Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70,166  
Center High Mounted Stop Light . . . . . . . . . . . . 289  
Central Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
Changing A Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230  
Chart, Tire Sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199  
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
Child Restraint Tether Anchors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55  
Child Restraint with Automatic Belts . . . . . . . . . . . 54  
Child Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21  
Child Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
Clean Air Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217  
Climate Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166  
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136  
Coin Holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112  
Compact Disc Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166  
Compact Disc Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138,144  
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210  
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105  
Compass Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107  
Compass Variance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106  
Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112  
Console, Overhead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104  
Contract, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318  
Cool Down, Turbo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182  
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290,291  
Coolant Pressure Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265  
Adding Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267  
Coolant Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266,268  
Disposal of Used Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266  
Drain, Flush, and Refill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266  
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268  
Points to Remember . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268  
Pressure Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX 329  
Radiator Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267  
Selection of Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267  
Corrosion Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276  
Crankcase Emission Control System . . . . . . . . . . 258  
Cruise Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133  
Cup Holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112  
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316  
Downshifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191  
Drive Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
Driving  
On Slippery Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238  
Electric Rear Window Defrost . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173  
Electric Remote Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
Electrical Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110  
Electronic Power Distribution Center . . . . . . . . . . 282  
Electronic Speed Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101  
Emergency, In Case of  
Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230  
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235  
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240  
Emergency Trunk Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29  
Emission Control System Maintenance . . . . . . 249,294  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246,247  
Break-In Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59  
Checking Oil Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251  
Dealer Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250  
Defroster, Rear Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173  
Defroster, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60,168,169  
Delay Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99  
Diagnostic System, Onboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248  
Dimmer Switch, Headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97  
Disposal  
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255  
Door Ajar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18  
Door Locks, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
330 INDEX  
Exhaust Gas Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220  
Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235  
Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251,290,291  
Oil Change Interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252  
Oil Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291  
Oil Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253  
Oil Synthetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255  
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130  
Timing Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258  
Engine Oil Viscosity Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254  
Exhaust Gas Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28,59,220,264  
Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264  
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255,291  
Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
Hazard Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
Flat Tire Stowage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235  
Flooded Engine Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181  
Fluid, Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292  
Fluid Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290  
Fluid Leaks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61  
Fluid Level Checks  
Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273  
Fog Light Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288  
Fog Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97,135  
Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86  
Freeing A Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216,291  
Adding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221  
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219  
Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290  
Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217  
Filler Location Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135  
Filters  
Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258  
Engine Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX 331  
Filler Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135,221  
Filler Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135  
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258  
Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129  
Hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135  
Octane Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
System Hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270  
Tank Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290  
Fueling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221  
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282  
Gauges  
Coolant Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131  
Gearshift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185  
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17,24  
General Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251  
Glass Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281  
Hands-Free Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70  
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85  
Headlights  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287  
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281  
High Beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97,131  
High Beam/ Low Beam Select Switch . . . . . . . . . 97  
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97  
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96  
Gas Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221  
Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216,290  
Gasoline, Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217  
Gasoline, Reformulated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
332 INDEX  
Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85  
Hood Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92  
Hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269  
Intermittent Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
Jack Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231  
Jack Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230,233  
Jacking Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233  
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235  
Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
Wiring System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14,27  
Indicator, Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132,134  
Infant Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51  
Inside Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67  
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126,129  
Instrument Panel and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125  
Instrument Panel Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281  
Instrument Panel Lens Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281  
Integrated Power Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282  
Interior Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280  
Interior Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285  
Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94  
Key, Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16  
Key Release Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13  
Key, Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16  
Key, Sentry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14  
Key-In Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14  
Keyless Entry System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
Knee Bolster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45,47  
Lane Change and Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130  
Lap/ Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX 333  
Latches  
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92  
High Beam Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131  
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96  
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94  
Liftgate Ajar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129  
Lights On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96  
Low Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135  
Malfunction Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134  
Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129  
Rear Servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288  
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131  
Security Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287  
Theft Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129  
Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132,134,197  
Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95,97,130,288  
Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129  
Warning (Instrument Cluster Description) . . . . . 129  
Loading Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202  
Lead Free Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
Light Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286,287  
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61,93  
Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45,50,60,134  
Anti-Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131  
Back-Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289  
Brake Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132  
Center Mounted Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289  
Courtesy/ Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93  
Daytime Running . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96  
Dimmer Switch, Headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95  
Engine Temperature Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130  
Fog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97,135,288  
Front Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287  
Headlight Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96  
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
334 INDEX  
Locks  
Downshifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191  
Fluid Level Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276  
Frequency of Fluid Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276  
Lubricant Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276  
Master Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271  
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67  
Electric Remote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
Outside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67  
Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67  
Vanity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69  
Modifications/ Alterations, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7  
Mopar Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250,321  
Multi-Function Control Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95  
Central . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
Child Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21  
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18  
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19  
Steering Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17  
Lubrication, Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262  
Luggage Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119  
Maintenance Free Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259  
Maintenance, General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251  
Maintenance Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251  
Maintenance Schedule  
Schedule ЉAЉ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305,309  
Schedule ЉBЉ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297  
Maintenance Schedules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294  
Malfunction Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134,249  
Manual, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322  
Manual Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180,189,276  
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161  
New Vehicle Break-In Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59  
Occupant Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32  
Octane Rating, Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX 335  
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133  
Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133,135  
Oil, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251,290  
Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290  
Change Interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252  
Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251  
Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255  
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255  
Identification Logo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254  
Materials Added to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255  
Quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254  
Recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253,290  
Synthetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255  
Viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254  
Oil Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129  
Onboard Diagnostic System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248,249  
Operator Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
Outside Air Intake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172  
Overdrive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186  
Overhead Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104  
Overhead Travel Information Center . . . . . . . . . . 104  
Overheating, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
Owners Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4,322  
Paint Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276  
Panel Rear Shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192  
Passing Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97  
Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58  
Phone, Cellular . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70  
Phone, Hands-Free . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70  
Placard, Tire and Loading Information . . . . . . . . . 202  
Power  
Distribution Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19  
Outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110  
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196,261  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
336 INDEX  
Steering, Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30  
Power Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292  
Pregnant Women and Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41  
Preparation for Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232  
Pretensioners  
Rear Shelf Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
Rear Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31  
Rear Window Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173  
Rear Window Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173  
Rear Wiper/ Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174  
Reclining Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84  
Recommended Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine  
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41  
Programming Transmitters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24  
Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291  
Remote Keyless Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286  
Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16  
Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250  
Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212  
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321  
Restraints, Child . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50,56  
Restraints, Infant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51  
Roof Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119  
Rotation, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215  
Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210  
Radiator Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267  
Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138,148,154  
Radio Broadcast Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136  
Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148,166  
Radio, Satellite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161  
Rear Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
Rear Seat, Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86,88  
Rear Seat Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX 337  
Safety Checks Inside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Safety Checks Outside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61  
Safety Defects, Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321  
Safety Information, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197  
Safety Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59  
Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161  
Satellite Radio Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164  
Schedule, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294  
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32  
Adjustable Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38  
Adjustable Upper Shoulder Anchorage . . . . . . . . 38  
And Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41  
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282  
Front Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
Pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41  
Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131  
Untwisting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39  
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82  
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85  
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85  
Height Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83  
Rear Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86,88  
Reclining . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84  
Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90  
Security Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
Sentry Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14,27  
Sentry Key Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16  
Service and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294  
Service Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316  
Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318  
Service Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136  
Severe Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297  
Shift Speeds, Manual Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190  
Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
338 INDEX  
Side Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47  
Side Window Demisters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173  
Slippery Surfaces, Driving On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238  
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231  
Spark Plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
Speed Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101,133  
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130  
Speedometer and Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126  
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180  
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180  
Engine Fails to Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181  
Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180  
Starting Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180  
Steering  
Storage Bin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
Stuck, Freeing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239  
Sulfur in Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218  
Sun Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108  
Sun Visor Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70  
Supplemental Restraint System - Airbag . . . . . . . . 41  
Synthetic Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255  
System, Navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131  
Temperature Gauge, Engine Coolant . . . . . . . 130,229  
Tether Anchor, Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55  
Theft Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
Theft System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
Tilt Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100  
Tire and Loading Information Placard . . . . . . . . . 202  
Tire Identification Number (TIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201  
Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197  
Tire Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197  
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196,261  
Tilt Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100  
Wheel Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17  
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114,285  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX 339  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61,206,323  
Air Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206  
Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213  
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230  
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210  
Flat Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235  
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206  
High Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209  
Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207  
Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230  
Load Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202,203  
Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323  
Radial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210  
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212  
Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215  
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197,206  
Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199  
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231  
Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211  
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212  
Towing  
Disabled Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240  
Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238  
Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100,132,134,196  
Traction Control Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100,196  
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223  
Minimum Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224  
Trailer and Tongue Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224  
Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223  
Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183  
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12,180,183,273  
Autostick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187  
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13,180,189  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183  
Overdrive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186  
Selection of Lubricant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
340 INDEX  
Transmitter Battery Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
Transmitter Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24  
Transmitter, Remote Keyless Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58  
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212  
Trip Odometer Reset Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133,135  
Trunk Release, Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29  
Turbo Cool Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182  
Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97,130  
Vehicle Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203,223  
Vehicle Modifications/ Alterations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7  
Vehicle Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285  
Vehicle Theft Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
Warning, Door Ajar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133  
Warning Lights (Instrument Cluster Description) . 129  
Warnings and Cautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6  
Warranty Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319  
Washer, Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175  
Washer, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174  
Washers, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98  
Washing Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277  
Wheel Alignment and Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213  
Wheel and Wheel Trim Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279  
Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32,109  
Window Fogging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30  
Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98  
Understanding Your Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . 125  
Uniform Tire Quality Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323  
Unleaded Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
Untwisting Procedure, Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39  
Vacuum/ Vapor Harnesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269  
Vanity Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69  
Variance, Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106  
Vehicle Identification Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX 341  
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98,263  
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263  
Wiper, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174  
Wipers, Intermittent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Belkin Bluetooth Headset F8T061 User Manual
Bionaire Electric Heater BCH3230 User Manual
Black Decker Blender FX350 User Manual
Boston Acoustics Speaker SUB10F User Manual
Briggs Stratton Portable Generator 206405GS User Manual
Broan Air Conditioner ERV90HCT User Manual
Brother All in One Printer NC 2200W User Manual
Cadence Treadmill WETL21021 User Manual
Canon DVD Recorder DW 100 User Manual
Chicago Electric Drill 67616 User Manual